- IBEX Global
Transcription
- IBEX Global
THIS DOCUMENT IS IMPORTANT AND REQUIRES YOUR IMMEDIATE ATTENTION. If you are in any doubt about the contents of this document, or the action you should take, you are recommended to seek immediately your own personal financial advice from your stockbroker, bank manager, solicitor, accountant or other independent financial adviser duly authorised under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended) (“FSMA”). This document, which comprises an AIM admission document drawn up in accordance with the AIM Rules for Companies, has been issued in connection with the application for admission to trading on AIM of the entire issued and to be issued ordinary share capital of the Company. This document does not constitute an offer or constitute any part of an offer to the public within the meaning of sections 85 and 102B of FSMA. Accordingly this document does not comprise a prospectus within the meaning of section 85 of FSMA and has not been drawn up in accordance with the Prospectus Rules or approved by or filed with the Financial Conduct Authority or any other competent authority. Application will be made for the New Ordinary Shares and the Existing Shares to be admitted to trading on AIM, a market operated by London Stock Exchange plc (the “London Stock Exchange”). AIM is a market designed primarily for emerging or smaller companies to which a higher investment risk tends to be attached than to larger or more established companies. AIM securities are not admitted to the Official List of the United Kingdom Listing Authority. A prospective investor should be aware of the risks of investing in such companies and should make the decision to invest only after careful consideration and, if appropriate, consultation with an independent financial adviser. Each AIM company is required pursuant to the AIM Rules for Companies to have a nominated adviser. The nominated adviser is required to make a declaration to the London Stock Exchange on Admission in the form set out in Schedule Two to the AIM Rules for Nominated Advisers. The London Stock Exchange has not itself examined or approved the contents of this document. The Directors, whose names appear on page 5 of this document, and the Company accept responsibility for the information contained in this document. To the best of the knowledge and belief of the Directors and the Company (who have taken all reasonable care to ensure that such is the case), the information contained in this document is in accordance with the facts and does not omit anything likely to affect the import of such information. All the Directors accept individual and collective responsibility for compliance with the AIM Rules for Companies. The whole of this document should be read. An investment in the Company is speculative. The attention of prospective investors is drawn in particular to Part 2 of this document which sets out certain risk factors relating to any investment in Ordinary Shares. All statements regarding the Group's business, financial position and prospects should be viewed in light of these risk factors. IBEX GLOBAL SOLUTIONS PLC (incorporated and registered in England and Wales with registered number 08462510) PLACING OF 7,304,345 ORDINARY SHARES AT £1.47 PER ORDINARY SHARE AND ADMISSION TO TRADING ON AIM NOMINATED ADVISER AND JOINT BROKER: JOINT BROKER: LIBERUM CAPITAL LIMITED CENKOS SECURITIES PLC SHARE CAPITAL (immediately following Admission) Issued and fully paid ordinary shares of £0.01 each Number £ 39,554,400 1.47 The New Ordinary Shares will rank pari passu in all respects with the Existing Shares and will rank in full for all dividends or other distributions declared, made or paid on the Ordinary Shares after Admission. It is expected that Admission will take place and that trading in the Ordinary Shares will commence on 28 June 2013. The Ordinary Shares are not traded on any recognised investment exchange and no other applications have been made. This document does not constitute an offer to sell or issue, or the solicitation of an offer to subscribe for or buy, Ordinary Shares to any person in any jurisdiction to whom it is unlawful to make such offer or solicitation. In particular, this document is not for distribution in or into the United States of America, Canada, Japan, the Republic of Ireland, the Republic of South Africa, Australia or New Zealand. The issue of the Ordinary Shares has not been, and will not be, registered under the applicable securities laws of the United States of America, Canada, Japan, the Republic of Ireland, the Republic of South Africa, Australia or New Zealand and the Ordinary Shares may not be offered or sold directly or indirectly within the United States of America, Canada, Japan, the Republic of Ireland, the Republic of South Africa, Australia or New Zealand or to, or for the account or benefit of, any persons within the United States of America, Canada, Japan, the Republic of Ireland, the Republic of South Africa, Australia or New Zealand. The distribution of this document in certain jurisdictions may be restricted by law and therefore persons into whose possession this document comes should inform themselves about and observe any such restriction. Any failure to comply with these restrictions may constitute a violation of the securities laws of any such jurisdiction. The Ordinary Shares have not and will not be registered under the US Securities Act of 1933 and may not be offered or sold within the United States. Liberum Capital Limited and Cenkos Securities PLC who are authorised and regulated in the United Kingdom by the Financial Conduct Authority are acting as nominated adviser and joint broker and joint broker respectively to the Company in connection with the proposed Placing and Admission and will not be acting for any other person or otherwise be responsible to any person for providing the protections afforded to customers of Liberum Capital Limited or Cenkos Securities PLC or for advising any other person in respect of the proposed Placing and Admission. Liberum Capital Limited's responsibilities as the Company's nominated adviser under the AIM Rules for Companies and the AIM Rules for Nominated Advisers are owed solely to the London Stock Exchange and are not owed to the Company or to any Director or to any other person in respect of such person's decision to acquire shares in the Company in reliance on any part of this document. No representation or warranty, express or implied, is made by Liberum Capital Limited or Cenkos Securities PLC as to any of the contents of this document (without limiting the statutory rights of any person to whom this document is issued) and neither Liberum Capital Limited nor Cenkos Securities PLC have authorised the contents of any part of this document and they accept no liability whatsoever for the accuracy of any information or opinions contained in this document or for the omission of any material information from this document for which the Company and the Directors are solely responsible. The information contained in this document has been prepared solely for the purposes of the Placing and Admission and is not intended to inform or be relied upon by any subsequent purchasers of Ordinary Shares (whether on or off market) and accordingly no duty of care is accepted in relation to them. Neither Liberum Capital Limited nor Cenkos Securities PLC have authorised the contents of any part of this document. Certain statements made in this document are forward looking statements. Such statements are based on current expectations and are subject to a number of risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results and performance to differ materially from any expected further results or performances, express or implied, by the forward looking statements. Certain statements in this document are based on preliminary unaudited financial results and management analysis and may differ from audited results. Factors that might cause forward-looking statements or statements based on unaudited figures to differ materially from actual results include, among other things, regulatory and economic factors. The Company, Liberum and Cenkos each disclaim any obligation to update any of the forward-looking statements or statements based on unaudited figures contained herein. Copies of this document will be available free of charge during normal business hours on any day (except Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays) at the offices of Mishcon de Reya, Summit House, 12 Red Lion Square, London WC1R 4QD from the date of this document until the date which is one month from the date of Admission. Additionally, an electronic version of this Document will be available on the Company’s website, www.ibexcorp.com. FORWARD LOOKING STATEMENTS This document includes statements that are, or may be deemed to be, “forward-looking statements”. These statements relate to, among other things, analyses and other information that are based on forecasts of future results and estimates of amounts not yet determinable. These statements also relate to the Group's future prospects, developments and business strategies. These forward-looking statements can be identified by their use of terms and phrases such as “anticipate”, “believe”, “could”, “estimate”, “expect”, “intend”, “may”, “plan”, “predict”, “project”, “will” or the negative of those variations, or comparable expressions, including references to assumptions. These statements are primarily contained in Part 1 of this document. The forward-looking statements in this document, including statements concerning projections of the Group’s future results, operations, profits and earnings, are based on current expectations and are subject to risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed or implied by those statements. Certain risks to and uncertainties for the Group are specifically described in Part 2 of this document headed “Risk Factors”. If one or more of these risks or uncertainties materialises, or if underlying assumptions prove incorrect, the Group’s actual results may vary materially from those expected, estimated or projected. Given these risks and uncertainties, potential investors should not place any reliance on forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements may and often do differ materially from actual results. Any forward-looking statements in this document are based on certain factors and assumptions, including the Directors’ current view with respect to future events and are subject to risks relating to future events and other risks, uncertainties and assumptions relating to the Group’s operations, results of operations, growth strategy and liquidity. Whilst the Directors consider these assumptions to be reasonable based upon information currently available, they may prove to be incorrect. Prospective investors should therefore specifically consider the risk factors contained in Part 2 of this document that could cause actual results to differ before making an investment decision. Save as required by law or by the AIM Rules, the Company undertakes no obligation to publicly release the results of any revisions to any forward-looking statements in this document that may occur due to any change in the Directors’ expectations or to reflect events or circumstances after the date of this document. MARKET AND FINANCIAL INFORMATION The data, statistics and information and other statements in this document regarding the markets in which the Group operates, or the Group’s position therein, are based on the Group’s records or are taken or derived from statistical data and information derived from the sources described in this document. In relation to these sources, such information has been accurately reproduced from the published information and, so far as the Directors are aware and are able to ascertain from the information provided by the suppliers of these sources, no facts have been omitted which would render such information inaccurate or misleading. Various figures and percentages in tables in this document have been rounded and accordingly may not total. Certain financial data has also been rounded. As a result of this rounding, the totals of data presented in this document may vary slightly from the actual arithmetical totals of such data. All times referred to in this document are, unless otherwise stated, references to London time. CURRENCIES Unless otherwise indicated, all references in this document to: (a) “$”, “US Dollar”, “dollars”, are to the lawful currency of the United States of America; (b) “GBP”, “£”, “pounds sterling”, “pounds”, “sterling”, “pence” or “p” are to the lawful currency of the United Kingdom; (c) “Francs” is to the lawful currency of Senegal; (d) “PP” is to the lawful currency of Philippines; and (e) “Rs” is to the lawful currency of Pakistan.” 2 CONTENTS Placing Statistics and Expected Timetable of Principal Events 4 Directors, Secretary and Advisers 5 Definitions 6 Part 1 Information on the Group 9 Part 2 Risk Factors 30 Part 3 Financial Information 38 Part A – Accountant’s Report on the Historical Financial Information of the Group for the three years ended 30 June 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 39 Part B – Historical Financial Information of the Group for the three years ended 30 June 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 41 Part C – Unaudited interim financial information of the Group for the six months ended 31 December 2011 (with audited comparatives for the six months ended 31 December 2012) 84 Part D – Unaudited interim financial information of the Group for the three months ended 31 March 2013 96 Part 4 – Additional Information 109 3 PLACING STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE OF PRINCIPAL EVENTS Placing Statistics Placing Price £1.47 Number of Existing Shares 32,250,055 Number of New Ordinary Shares 7,304,345 Number of Sale Shares 2,596,123 Number of Placing Shares 9,900,468 Enlarged Share Capital 39,554,400 Proportion of Enlarged Share Capital represented by Placing Shares 25 per cent. Market capitalisation at the Placing Price £58.1 million Gross proceeds of the Placing £14.6 million Gross proceeds of the Placing attributable to the New Ordinary Shares £10.7 million Net proceeds of the Placing attributable to the New Ordinary Shares Ticker £9.3 million IBEX ISIN GB00BBCRF441 SEDOL BBCRF44 Expected Timetable of Principal Events Event Time and Date Publication of this document 24 June 2013 Admission effective and dealings commence on AIM 8.00 a.m. on 28 June 2013 CREST accounts to be credited in respect of Placing Shares 8.00 a.m. on 28 June 2013 Despatch of definitive share certificates for Placing Shares (where applicable) by 5 July 2013 Each of the times and dates set out above and mentioned elsewhere in this document may be subject to change at the absolute discretion of the Company, Liberum and Cenkos without further notice. Exchange Rate Prevailing exchange rate as the latest practicable date prior to the publication of this document 4 £=US$1.546 DIRECTORS, SECRETARY AND ADVISERS Directors Stephen Kezirian (Chief Executive Officer) Karl Gabel (Chief Financial Officer) Muhammad Ziaullah Khan (“Zia”) Chishti (Non-executive Chairman) Mohammedulla Khaishgi (Non-executive Director) Tim Kelly (Non-executive Director) John Leone (Non-executive Director) Corporate Secretary Jimmy Holland Registered Office 3rd Floor 5 Lloyds Avenue London EC3N 3AE Website www.ibexglobal.com Nominated Adviser and Joint Broker Liberum Capital Limited Ropemaker Place, Level 12 25 Ropemaker Street London EC2Y 9LY Joint Broker Cenkos Securities plc 6.7.8 Tokenhouse Yard London EC2R 7AS Legal advisers to the Group Mishcon de Reya Summit House 12 Red Lion Square London WC1R 4QD Legal advisers to the Nominated Adviser and Joint Brokers Stephenson Harwood LLP 1 Finsbury Circus London EC2M 7SH Auditors to the Group Grant Thornton UK LLP Grant Thornton House Melton Street London NW1 2EP Reporting Accountant Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU Registrar Capita Registrars Limited The Registry 34 Beckenham Road Beckenham Kent BR3 4TU Public Relations adviser to the Group Tavistock Communications Limited 131 Finsbury Pavement London EC2A 1NT 5 DEFINITIONS Act the Companies Act 2006 Admission admission of the issued and to be issued share capital of the Company to trading on AIM becoming effective in accordance with the AIM Rules AIM AIM, a market operated by the London Stock Exchange AIM Rules the AIM Rules for Companies issued by the London Stock Exchange and those of its other rules which govern the admission to trading on, and the operation of companies on, AIM Articles the articles of association of the Company Board or Directors the board of directors of the Company as at Admission whose names are set out on page 5 of this document Cenkos Cenkos Securities plc, of 6.7.8 Tokenhouse Yard, London, EC2R 7AS, joint broker to the Company certificated or in certificated form in physical paper form (that is, not in CREST) City Code or Code the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers Company IBEX Global Solutions PLC Companies Acts the meaning contained in section 2 of the Act CREST the relevant system (as defined in the UK CREST Regulations) in respect of which Euroclear UK &Ireland Limited is the Operator (as defined in the UK CREST Regulations) CREST Regulations the Uncertificated Securities Regulations 2001, as amended CY the calendar year ended 31 December EBITDA earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation Enlarged Share Capital the Existing Shares and the New Ordinary Shares Existing Shares the 32,250,055 Ordinary Shares in issue prior to the Placing FCA the Financial Conduct Authority FY the financial year of the Group ended 30 June Group or IBEX the Company and its direct and indirect subsidiaries Historical Financial Information historical financial information for the three years ended 30 June 2012 and the six months ended 31 December 2012 prepared specifically for inclusion in this document IBEX Inc. TRG Customer Solutions, Inc. the main US operating subsidiary of the Group ISIN International Securities Identification Number 6 Liberum Liberum Capital Limited, of Ropemaker Place, Level 12, 25 Ropemaker Street, London EC2Y 9LY, nominated adviser and joint broker to the Company Lock-in and Orderly Market Agreements the conditional lock-in and orderly marketing agreements dated 24 June 2013 between (1) Liberum, (2) Cenkos, (3) each of the Directors and TRGI, further details of which are set out in paragraph 12.3 of Part 4 of this document London Stock Exchange London Stock Exchange plc New Ordinary Shares the 7,304,345 new Ordinary Shares to be issued at the Placing Price by the Company pursuant to the Placing Ordinary Shares ordinary shares of £0.01 each in the capital of the Company Panel the Panel on Takeovers and Mergers Placees the subscribers for Placing Shares pursuant to the Placing Placing the conditional placing by Liberum and Cenkos of the New Ordinary Shares and the Sale Shares pursuant to and on the terms and conditions set out in the Placing Agreement Placing Agreement the conditional agreement dated 24 June 2013 relating to the Placing between (1) the Company, (2) the Directors, (3) TRGI, (4) Liberum and (5) Cenkos, further details of which are set out in paragraph 12.1 of Part 4 of this document Placing Price £1.47 per Placing Share Placing Shares the New Ordinary Shares and the Sale Shares QCA Quoted Companies Alliance Registrars Capita Registrars Limited Reorganisation means the reorganisation of the Group described in paragraph 11 of Part 4 Sale Shares the 2,596,123 Existing Shares to be sold at the Placing Price by TRGI pursuant to the Placing Securities Act the US Securities Act of 1933 (as amended) Share Option Plans (a) the employee share option scheme named the IBEX Global Solutions PLC Share Option Plan intended to be adopted by the Company following Admission and (b) the employee stock option plan adopted between TRGI and the Company, details of which are set out in paragraphs 4.1 and 4.2 of Part 4 of this document Shareholders holders of Ordinary Shares from time to time, following Admission TIDM Tradable Investment Display Mnemonic TRG or The Resource Group TRGI and its direct and indirect subsidiaries TRGI The Resource Group International Limited, a substantial shareholder of the Company 7 uncertificated or in uncertificated form Ordinary Shares held in uncertificated form in CREST and title to which, by virtue of the CREST Regulations, may be transferred by means of CREST United Kingdom or UK the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland UK Corporate Governance Code the Corporate Governance Code on the principles of good corporate governance and code of best practice published in September 2012 by the Financial Reporting Council US the United States of America £ pounds sterling, the lawful currency of the United Kingdom $ dollar, the lawful currency of the United States of America VAT Value Added Tax Note: Any reference to any provision of any legislation includes any amendment, modification, re-enactment or extension of it. Words importing the singular include the plural and vice versa and words importing the masculine gender shall include the feminine or neuter gender. 8 PART 1 INFORMATION RELATING TO THE GROUP 1. Overview IBEX provides contact centre services and other business process outsourcing solutions to enterprise customers. Over the past two years, IBEX has increased revenues at a compound annual growth rate of 16 per cent. and for the year ended 31 March 2013 IBEX generated unaudited revenues of $126.7 million. IBEX employs approximately 8,000 staff in sixteen locations situated in five countries, and provides services in eleven languages. IBEX has over 70 enterprise clients, with the Group’s five largest clients comprising 74 per cent. of FY 2012 revenues. The Directors believe that the Group’s mix of business provides for revenue and profit stability and predictability. Over 90 per cent. of the Group’s revenues derive from contact centre market segments that involve extensive agent training, are essential to the Group’s clients’ ongoing corporate performance, and can be difficult for clients to replace. Such segments include inbound customer support, inbound technical assistance, and inbound sales order entry. Essentially all of the Group’s revenues derive from customer contracts that provide for compensation based primarily on units of dedicated agent time, a measure that is largely correlated to the Group’s costs. The Group derives approximately 90 per cent. of its revenues from clients based in the US. The majority of these revenues are served “onshore” from the Group’s eight locations in the US and the remainder is served “offshore” with three locations in the Philippines and one in Senegal. Corporations have increasingly chosen to outsource non-core business processes because of the potential benefits of specialisation and cost efficiency provided by external vendors. During CY 2012, corporations spent $290 billion globally on the outsourcing of business processes from remote locations. Of this total, $58 billion was spent on the outsourcing of voice-based services such as customer service, technical support and customer acquisition and retention, an amount forecasted to grow at a compound rate of over 5 per cent. for the next five years. In 2011 and 2012, the Group initiated and pursued a strategy of increasing operating scale through organic growth substantially in excess of industry levels, if necessary prioritising growth over short-term profitability. As a consequence, in 2011 the Group reorganised its management team, recruiting Steve Kezirian as Chief Executive Officer and Julie Casteel as Chief Sales and Marketing Officer with a mandate to focus on growth from existing customers and the addition of new enterprise customers. This strategy has been a success and the early investment in growth has resulted in an increase in revenues and profitability to the business together with further opportunities to continue growth. In the first calendar quarter of 2013, Group revenues increased 30.6 per cent. and EBITDA increased 116 per cent. respectively over the comparable quarter in 2012. The Group intends to continue its strategy of revenue growth through increased market share within its current portfolio of clients together with the acquisition of new enterprise customers. At present, the Group has a focus on US consumer technology and telecommunications companies. To diversify its revenues, the Group intends to acquire clients in complementary industries such as health care and utilities and in geographies such as Canada, the United Kingdom and France, where the Group either has incumbent customers or possess language and delivery capability. In conjunction with its strategy of increasing revenues, the Group has also focused on maintaining efficient variable and fixed cost structures. The majority of the Group’s variable costs consist of labour expenses. Accordingly, the Group focuses heavily on understanding the labour markets in which it operates and on targeting wage and benefit levels for its staff that result in an optimal labour cost structure. Over the past three years, this focus has contributed to an improvement in annual staff retention rates of over 20 per cent. The Group has also pursued a strategy of minimising fixed overhead expenses by locating the majority of its support functions in cost-efficient locations such as Pakistan and the Philippines, carefully managing telecommunications costs and deploying internally developed and scalable management processes and systems. The Directors believe that IBEX’s efficient cost structure is a key advantage for the Group. 9 2. Key Strengths The Directors consider that IBEX has the following key strengths: Management quality, depth, and alignment The Group’s senior leadership team has over one hundred combined years of experience within the contact centre industry. The Group’s Chief Executive Officer developed extensive experience in managing large scale internal and outsourced contact centre operations during his positions as Vice President of Telesales at Sprint Nextel Corporation and Chief Operating Officer of Cantor Gaming. The Group’s Chief Sales and Marketing Officer has been in senior business development roles in the business process outsourcing industry since 1990, and was responsible for new business development at one of IBEX’s competitors as it grew from $30 million in annual revenues to over $1.7 billion over the course of her eleven year tenure. The Group’s Chief Financial Officer and the Group’s Senior Vice President of North American Operations each have over sixteen years of experience within IBEX or its predecessor businesses. Investment in contact centre agent human capital The Directors believe that the Group’s culture, compensation and benefit structure for its contact centre agents represent a key differentiator within the industry. The Group maintains a deep commitment to its core values of integrity, openness, and collegiality that the Directors believe help to facilitate the recruitment, training and maintenance of an industry-leading workforce. IBEX has consistently sought to innovate in the employee recruitment process, with particular emphasis on digital tools such as social media and online recruitment, together with traditional channels of print and other broadcast media. The Group has invested heavily in developing proprietary models and processes for correlating employee compensation with employee retention and for setting efficient compensation levels consistent with maximising its performance and profitability. This investment has resulted in a steadily improving employee retention profile over the past three years while at the same time increasing Group margins and profitability and improving the Group’s performance on its key accounts. Performance focus The Directors believe that the Group has deployed a culture of performance measurement and management that has contributed significantly to the Group’s recent growth. The Group seeks to carefully understand its clients’ principal operating metrics and then to manage its operations in order to optimise those metrics. The Group maintains detailed daily, weekly, monthly and quarterly internal reviews of performance and actively shifts operational focus in response to changing conditions. The Directors believe that this focus has led to the Group’s clients perceiving IBEX as consistently meeting or exceeding key client performance metrics which, in turn, has been a significant driver of the Group’s growth. Durable and scalable incumbent client relationships In the first calendar quarter of 2013 over 70 per cent. of the Group’s revenues derived from Fortune 500 companies that have been clients of the Group for over five years. Of the Group’s increase in revenues over the last three years, approximately 45 per cent. is derived from net growth in business from existing clients of the Group. The Directors believe that the Group’s enterprise clients place strong emphasis on the quality and continuity of their customer-facing operations, consider IBEX in good standing and continue to represent a substantial opportunity for the Group’s growth. All of the Group’s clients are contracted directly with the Group, and, in aggregate, have a weighted average tenure with IBEX that exceeds five years. Full service provider The Group provides a full suite of contact centre services to its clients including 24/7 inbound and outbound support, support in eleven languages, multi-site and multi-geography redundancy, an internally redundant and global MPLS telecommunications network, call and screen recording and analysis, and support for industry-standard technologies provided by Avaya, Cisco, Genesys, IEX/NICE and SATMAP. The Group maintains experience in the telecommunications, technology, financial services, consumer retail, healthcare, utility, media, travel and hospitality industries. The Group maintains deployments including groups of shared agents to as many as 1,600 dedicated agents to certain significant clients. Accordingly, the Directors believe that the Group favourably compares in the range and depth of its services relative to its competitors. 10 Large market opportunity The global outsourced contact centre industry represents a $58 billion per annum opportunity growing at over 5 per cent. per year, with certain segments that are a focus of the Group such as offshore contact centre outsourcing growing at over 25 per cent. annually. The outsourced industry is highly fragmented, with the top 10 providers possessing less than a cumulative 30 per cent. market share. At present the Group has less than a 1 per cent. market share within its industry. As such, the Directors believe that there is significant opportunity for the Group to continue its rapid growth, both organically as the Group continues to benefit from industry expansion and increasing market share, as well as inorganically through selective acquisitions. 3. History and Background The origins of the Group are in a $1.5 million investment in 2002 by TRG, a specialist investor in and advisor to the business process outsourcing industry, in exchange for a 49 per cent. interest in a $7 million annual revenue contact centre business named Alert Communications located in Los Angeles, California. At the time of TRG’s investment, Alert Communications was recording annual EBITDA losses approaching $1 million, reflecting an EBITDA margin of negative 15 per cent. Shortly after making its investment, TRG proceeded to implement a program of relocating significant portions of Alert Communications agent and support staff to lower-wage offshore locations. This program contributed towards moving Alert Communications to profitability and validated a central assumption of TRG that substantial operational efficiencies existed within the broader contact centre industry and could be captured through management focus and strength. Subsequently, TRG proceeded to acquire and subsequently amalgamate a further six contact centre businesses into the Group as it is constituted today. The seven businesses that are combined within IBEX are: Year Business Year of TRG transferred Annual lines acquisition/ to IBEX revenue at transferred investment control transfer to IBEX Alert Communications iSky1 (contact centre carve out) 2002 2004 2007 2007 $3 million $17 million Telespectrum 2004 2004 $60 million Reese Teleservices 2005 2005 $40 million Callworx 2005 2007 $3 million Virtual World 2006 2013 $5 million TRG Marketing Solutions 2009 2013 $2 million Inbound customer care Outbound customer satisfaction surveys and inbound customer care Inbound and outbound contact centre services for large enterprises Outbound customer acquisition services for large enterprises Outbound customer acquisition services from the Philippines Inbound contact centre services for large enterprises in Pakistan Inbound and outbound contact centre services for large enterprises in the U.K. 1 Reflects contact centre operations of iSky only. iSky’s primary business was and continues to be customer experience management. At the time of their acquisition, both Reese Teleservices and Telespectrum had a substantial proportion of their business mix devoted to outbound customer acquisition. This business mix was adversely impacted by a combination of regulatory changes in the United States, such as federal “Do Not Call” legislation, and increasing consumer resistance to outbound telemarking efforts. In addition, by 2006 it had become clear that the technology and back office support platforms for both Reese and Telespectrum required significant investment in order to remain competitive. In its role as controlling shareholder, TRG responded to these shifts by operationally combining Reese Teleservices, Telespectrum and Alert Communications and commenced the process of repositioning the combined business as a global provider of high-value inbound customer care and technical support contact centre services. The combination of the three businesses was branded TRG Customer Solutions 11 or “TRGCS”. The Resource Group acquired Callworx in the Philippines in 2005 to help establish a significant offshore presence and transferred the operations to TRGCS management in 2007. By 2007 this set of steps had resulted in TRGCS having a consolidated technology, support and management structure. In the midst of the global financial crisis that started in 2008, TRGCS underwent a significant reduction in revenues as several of its key customers reduced outsourced, outbound call volumes which, in turn, substantially reduced profitability. TRGCS responded by further shifting its business mix towards more stable, predictable and scaleable inbound customer care and technical support, closing five of its unprofitable facilities, selling its sub-scale Canadian operations and substantially reducing its fixed costs. By 2009, TRGCS had returned to profitability and by 2010 over 80 per cent. of its revenue was derived from inbound customer care and technical support services. Between 2010 and 2012, TRGCS made the strategic decision to invest heavily in management, a low cost back office and support infrastructure, enhanced operational facilities and contact centre agents that would support rapid revenue growth. Over this period, TRGCS recruited its current Chief Executive Officer, Steve Kezirian and its current Chief Sales and Marketing Officer, Julie Casteel. Mr. Kezirian had substantial experience in managing large scale internally and externally sourced inbound contact centres, having held senior executive positions with Sprint Nextel, Tickets.com and Cantor Gaming. Similarly, Ms. Casteel had demonstrated substantial new business development credentials, having served as EVP of Global Sales and Marketing at Sitel, a competing provider of outsourced contact centre services, during its growth from $30 million in annual revenues to over $1.7 billion in annual revenues. In parallel, TRGCS renovated its existing network of seven continuing sites to adapt to its new business model and opened three new sites that were specifically developed to serve enterprise-level inbound contact centre services. Finally, over this period, TRGCS invested in the large scale recruitment and training of contact centre agents to help execute against its rapidly growing revenue opportunity. In March 2013, TRGCS rebranded itself as IBEX Global Solutions, completing its emergence as a global provider of sophisticated, enterprise-scale contact centre solutions. Also in March 2013, TRG contributed the balance of its contact centre assets to IBEX Global Solutions, gaining the Group significant operations in the United Kingdom, Senegal, and Pakistan and establishing the Group’s final overall operating structure. As of the time of this document, the Group has no material dependency on or obligations to TRG. The Directors believe that, as a consequence of its efforts over the past five years, the Group has emerged as a formidable competitor in the contact centre outsourcing industry, with a growing presence in the broader business process outsourcing arena. Over the past two years, IBEX has increased revenues at a compound annual growth rate of 16 per cent. and for the year ended 31 March 2013 IBEX generated unaudited revenues of $126.7 million. 12 4. Company Structure IBEX is structured as a United Kingdom holding company owning a series of operating and billing subsidiaries. A diagram of the corporate structure is shown below: Note: The structure chart above does not, in all cases, reflect the actual corporate names of the relevant entities. They have been named by their country of incorporation and operation for ease of reference. * Minority holdings in these companies are held by third parties. Please see paragraph 1.7 of Part 4 for more information. The IBEX corporate structure is designed so as to upstream all profitability into the holding Company in a tax efficient manner. The main companies within the corporate structure are (current legal name mentioned in parentheses wherever applicable): Group Holding Company: ● IBEX Global Solutions PLC. The IBEX holding company, which is seeking Admission to the London Stock Exchange and which will receive proceeds raised from the offering. This holding company does not have any client contracts or employ any IBEX staff. Client Contracting and Onshore Service Delivery Entities: ● IBEX US (TRG Customer Solutions Inc). – The US operating company, which holds all contracts relating to North American clients and also employs all US based staff. ● IBEX UK. (TRG Marketing Solutions Limited) – The UK operating company, which holds contracts relating to UK clients and also employs all UK based staff. ● Virtual World (Virtual World (Pvt) Limited) – This company holds all contracts relating to Pakistani clients and employs all the Pakistan based staff dedicated exclusively to the domestic Pakistan business. Offshore Service Delivery Entities: ● IBEX Philippines (TRG Philippines Inc) – This company employs all the IBEX Philippines employees. It does not have any external client contracts and provides services to IBEX’s operating companies. ● IBEX Global (Pvt) Limited – This company employs all the IBEX employees in Pakistan that provide services to IBEX’s international operations. It does not hold any external client contracts. 13 ● IBEX Senegal (The Resource Group Senegal S.A) – This company employs all the IBEX Senegal employees. It provides services to IBEX’s operating companies and also has one domestic client. IP and Offshore Service Billing Entities: ● IBEX Luxembourg (IBEX Global Europe S.a.r.l.) – This company holds IBEX’s intellectual property. It charges a royalty payment to the operating companies that utilize its intellectual property in order to deliver services. Any profitability generated within this company is paid to the Company in the form of dividends. ● IBEX Cyprus (Lovercius Consultants Ltd.) – This company is a pass-through billing entity related to offshore services. It contracts with various IBEX operating companies to provide offshore services and sources these services from IBEX’s various offshore entities. The Group structure was put in place as part of the Reorganisation, further details of which are set out in paragraph 11 of Part 4. 5. IBEX’s Business Process Overview The majority of IBEX’s clients are corporations that outsource some or all of their contact centre operations. The Group’s specialisation is in the voice-based contact centre services area where it provides a complete suite of voice-based services to clients. Some of these services include inbound technical support, inbound customer care, inbound sales, inbound customer retention and outbound customer acquisition. In a typical inbound voice-based engagement, customer calls made to the client’s toll free numbers are routed (through leased lines sourced from a major telecommunications carrier) to IBEX’s PBX located at its two data centres. Those data centres are connected to each of the Group’s contact centre facilities through a private cloud. The call thus received at IBEX’s PBX is routed, via that private cloud, to the relevant group of agents dedicated to that client/program and located within one of IBEX’s facilities. Concurrent with the routing of the call (to the relevant agent), the Group’s centralised database servers trigger display on the agent’s computer of software specific to the client program containing the call script as well as input screens where the agent can enter information pertaining to the call. In order to manage the large number of agents dedicated to each client program, the Group maintains an operations management infrastructure. The central person within that infrastructure is the “supervisor”, who is responsible for overseeing, motivating and coaching a group of twelve to eighteen agents and provides coaching, motivation and monitoring to those agents. Each group of five to seven supervisors is overseen by an “operations manager”, who has broad responsibility over the delivery of performance and customer satisfaction goals. Within each facility, there are typically several operations managers who are managed by a “site director” having responsibility over the entire facility. The Group undertakes recruiting, training and quality monitoring programs with an objective of providing an effective level of service delivery. It maintains a team of dedicated recruiters who specialise in identifying and hiring appropriate talent for each client campaign. It also maintains a team of client-certified trainers within each facility that work closely with each client so that appropriate baseline and client-specific training is provided to each agent before going live on a client’s program. Once a client program is live, IBEX’s network of quality assurance personnel monitor agent performance closely to adhere to client performance objectives and to provide feedback to supervisors and operations managers for continuous agent improvement. The quality assurance function for the Group is largely centralised and based in the Group’s Philippines facilities, other than a few clients for whom quality assurance is carried out on-site at the facility providing services to those clients. The Group has a consolidated reporting and analytics database, IBEX Insight, that is intended to enable the Group to provide a high quality of service delivery at cost-efficient levels. IBEX Insight tracks client objectives such as Average Speed of Answer (the time it takes for an incoming call to be attended to by a live agent) or Customer Satisfaction scores provided by third party monitoring services or sales metrics such as Sales per Hour (in the case of sales-oriented programs). In addition, IBEX Insight also tracks cost efficiency metrics such as Production to Pay (the percentage of payroll time that an agent is available to take a call), Occupancy (the percentage of available time that an agent actually spends talking on the 14 phone), or Attrition (the number of agents leaving the employee base each month at a given site/program, expressed as a percentage of the overall agent population for that site/program). IBEX Insight is designed to provide real-time data wherever possible and is intended to allow the Group’s operations management to take early action in the event of any issues relating to effective service delivery. The Group provides two other centralised support functions to ensure smooth service delivery. Its inbound operations are heavily dependent upon a workforce management function, which is responsible for determining staffing levels and schedules given call volumes provided by a client. The Group’s global workforce management function is predominantly centralised and staffed out of the Group’s Philippines facilities. The Group also maintains a pool of software developers, who are responsible for setting up and maintaining the databases and reporting systems that support its call programs. The Group’s software and technology function is largely centralised and provided from its Pakistan facilities. The Group’s business process includes the client services function, which is distinct from the operations organisation. Each large client has a dedicated client services executive that acts as the “voice of the customer” within the Group and seeks to maximize client satisfaction, which in turn sets the stage for the Group to increase its scope of work. This person is responsible for all day-to-day engagement with the client and is tasked with ensuring that client requests are effectively carried out by the operations organisation. The client service executive is also responsible for managing (from the Group’s side) the quarterly business review process with the client, where the Group and the client discuss program performance, near-term business outlook and value-added insights geared towards improving client-driven metrics. The client services function has an independent reporting line into the Group CEO which allows for a rapid feedback loop in the event of any client dissatisfaction. The Group also offers an increasingly wide range of associated non-voice services (such as chat or email support or back-office services such as fraud prevention or sales support). The revenues associated with such services are relatively low at present but growing especially as the Group gains referenceable nonvoice clients. Revenue model The majority of the Group’s revenues are based upon a “price per minute” model where the Group charges its clients a base rate per minute of time that an agent was actively servicing the client’s customers (more commonly known as talk time, hold time and after-call work). Base rates are then adjusted up or down depending upon the Group’s performance against metrics agreed with each client. As the Group diversifies its service offering beyond outsourced contact centres, pricing structures become more varied. The back office services offering, in particular, presents a wide variety of revenue models given the less-uniform nature of services provided by each group of agents. In one instance, the Group has adopted a cost-plus model where its client pays an overhead charge (which includes a margin for the Group) over and beyond the direct cost of the employee. In another instance, where the contractual arrangement is for the Group to manage the client’s captive centre, the Group is simply paid for its management services (in operating the centres) whereas all other costs are paid directly by the client. Key Operational Efficiency Drivers A key operational efficiency consideration for the Group is to ensure that it staffs its call centres efficiently given incoming call volumes and patterns. This is particularly important in the “price per minute” revenue model where the workforce management responsibility is generally borne by the Group. In order to perform effectively the Group attempts to protect itself against volume shortfalls by negotiating to have the client confirm its forecast call volumes within 60-90 days before the start of each month and by having the client pay for any significant shortfalls in forecast variances. Such arrangements vary from client to client; in some cases, the client takes a different approach by requiring the Group’s agents (together with agents of all other vendors servicing that client) to log directly into its own PBX, rather than delivering calls into the Group’s PBX. In such cases, the client’s system will determine which vendor receives the next inbound call, not the Group’s PBX, therefore the Group no longer controls workforce management. In such circumstances it is however protected from significant volume and occupancy volatility because the client compensates the Group to maintain a specified level of dedicated agents. The largest portion of the Group’s variable costs is attributable to agent labour expenses. Accordingly, efficient management of the cost of agent labour (including training costs) is key to the Group’s profitability. 15 The Group attempts to strike a balance between maintaining competitive compensation levels so as to minimise agent attrition and target a high quality workforce that exceeds client metrics, but keeps compensation at levels that enable the Group to remain profitable. The Directors believe that the Group is known for agent compensation levels that are above average and further believe that this is a key consideration in the Group’s revenue growth over the last two years. In particular, the Group is highly focused on keeping attrition levels low, given that attrition has an outsized impact on Company profitability both through the cost of replacement training and through foregone margin associated with a departing employee. In addition, the Directors believe that employees with higher tenure would have a tendency to perform better, thereby improving client metrics and therefore, the Directors believe, more easily growing the Group’s share of the client’s outsourcing spend. 6. Overview of the Market For the year ended 31 December 2012, corporations globally are estimated to have spent $290 billion on business process outsourcing. Of this amount, approximately $58 billion was spent on outsourced voicebased contact centre services, whereas the remaining amount was spent on non-voice services such as finance and accounting outsourcing, payroll and benefits administration and various types of industry specific outsourcing such as insurance claims processing or bank mortgage processing or telecom/utilities billing. The global outsourced contact centre services spend of $58 billion is part of an overall global spend of $234 billion in 2012 for all contact centre services (whether outsourced or in-house). While the proportion of outsourcing within this overall figure is growing significantly, most corporations continue to use in-house resources for their contact centre estate. HfS Research estimates that the global outsourced contact centre market will grow by 5.5 per cent. per year to $73 billion by 2016. Within the global outsourced contact centre services market, the North American region makes up approximately 48 per cent. (or $28 billion per year) whereas the European region makes up a further 35 per cent. Within the North American region, 25 per cent. of services (by revenue) are provided from an offshore location (primarily the Philippines, followed by India) while 75 per cent. are provided by agents located within North America. In terms of industry breakdown, 65 per cent. of all outsourced contact centre revenues correspond to the financial services and telecommunications/media industries. These industries make up a large portion of the outsourced contact centre services industry because customer-facing support within these industries is characterised by a high number of repetitive, transactional interactions that are amenable to contact centre delivery. Other verticals within the outsourced contact centre services industry that are experiencing high growth include the utilities and insurance industries. Due to the lower billing rates for offshore service delivery (which bills on average at around 40-50 per cent. of US based service delivery rates), the overall industry growth in dollar terms understates the true growth in headcount terms given the increasing proportion of offshore agents. The Philippines offshore contact centre market has, in particular, been expanding rapidly with $8 billion in revenues in 2012, corresponding to 500,000 employees and growing at 25 per cent. per year. Of these, approximately 350,000 contact centre employees serve the US market, compared to a US-based call centre workforce of nearly 4 million. The Group’s principal addressable market has to date been the $28 billion outsourced North American contact centre services market. The Group currently has a 0.5 per cent. share of this principal addressable market. The Directors believe that the Group has the opportunity to increase this market share significantly given its emphasis on quality of service delivery and the referenceability associated with its recent growth within its two largest clients. In addition to growing its principal addressable market, the Group intends to focus on two other market segments. Firstly, it intends to diversify its contact centre reach by expanding into the European outsourced contact centre market, particularly in the United Kingdom (where it already has a presence and a client base) and France (where it has language specific delivery capabilities through its presence in Senegal). Secondly, it intends to broaden its offering into other non-voice BPO areas, especially customer-facing areas such as email support, chat and website administration but also finance and accounting and HR administration services, where the Group has developed an initial presence over the last 12-18 months. Both the above markets represent significant addressable opportunities, with the UK and French outsourced contact centre market size estimated collectively at $10 billion per year, and the finance, accounting and HR outsourcing market size estimated at $65 billion per year. 16 Finally, the Group has a niche presence in the domestic BPO market in Pakistan through its Virtual World subsidiary which is the leading local outsourced contact centre provider. The market for BPO services purchased by domestic corporations in Pakistan is below $50 million per year, with the Group having a 10 per cent. share at $5 million per annum. Competition The Group operates in a highly competitive environment. The global outsourced contact centre services industry is characterised by large number of providers of significant scale. The largest provider (by revenues) is Teleperformance with annual revenues of $3 billion and employee headcount of 128,000. The 20th largest global pureplay provider of outsourced contact centre services (EXL) has revenues of $450 million and headcount of 21,000. The above list does not include diversified professional services providers that also offer outsourced contact centre services among their suite of offerings. The top twenty providers constitute approximately 50 per cent. of the worldwide market (by revenues) for outsourced contact centre services. The remaining 50 per cent. consists either of a large number of providers that specialise in a particular industry or geography or a smaller number of diversified, global providers generating below $400 million in annual revenue per annum. The Directors believe that subsequent to its recent growth, IBEX would fit better within the latter category, which provides it with the capability to compete head to head with larger vendors. 7. Infrastructure, Technology, and Intellectual Property Infrastructure The Group provides voice-based services from a series of contact centre facilities across the globe as detailed in the chart below. Facilities are primarily selected based upon availability of cost competitive and well-educated agent populations. Within the US, those considerations drive the Group towards mid-sized towns, often with some degree of depressed economic activity, that have sufficient critical population mass to allow for recruitment of large groups of appropriately skilled labour. Outside the US, the Group’s principal presence is in the Philippines, which is the largest and fastest growing contact centre services location worldwide. Within the Philippines, the Group has historically focused its presence to the capital city of Manila. However, given significant wage inflation and fixed cost pressures in Manila, the Group is actively considering situating its next facility in a provincial city. The Group also has a sizeable presence in Pakistan. The Pakistan location has limited international client facing activity given perception of country risk and the Group has chosen to leverage the unsaturated labour pool for many of its in-house operations such as technology and analytics. The Directors believe that the Group’s access to the Pakistan labour pool provides it with a significant competitive advantage. The chart below provides a list of the Group’s current contact centre locations. 17 The Group deploys various financial and operational arrangements that allow it to expand its facility footprint in line with its revenues, without incurring significant up-front capital expenditures in the process. Within the US, the Group aggressively negotiates with landlords as well as state governments to share the cost of up front capital expenditures against long term lease or headcount commitments. The Group also works actively with site selection firms who help identify facilities that are consistent with the Group’s approach. Within the Philippines, where the market is more competitive and landlord-friendly, the Group works with infrastructure leasing companies to vary the cost of upfront fit-out of new facility space. Network Central to the Group’s business is the use of a robust global telecommunications network that connects its agents to callers and to the databases that access information related to each call. The Group’s global network is based upon the design principle of maintaining all core infrastructure (such as its PBX, servers and databases) within a centralised, secure data centre which is in turn connected to its various locations that house its agent workforce. The Group maintains two data centres in Hampton, VA and Pittsburgh, PA; these two facilities are designed to cut over to each other in the event of an outage in any one data centre. Given the above design, each contact centre location only contains the computer desktops supporting each agent workstation as well as routers and switches that support these computers. For its telecommunications lines connecting the data centres to callers and agents, the Group uses two types of circuits. For connectivity to callers, the Group has dedicated leased telecommunications lines that connect its data centres to the telecommunications carrier switching network. Clients instruct their carriers to forward their toll free numbers to these dedicated lines; similarly for outbound traffic, the calls placed by the Group’s agents are routed to the carrier network through these dedicated lines. For connectivity to agents, the Group links its data centres to its contact centre facilities through a private cloud, which is effectively a virtual leased line network, with the benefit of near 100 per cent. uptime given routing flexibility by the carrier in the event of downtime on any one circuit path. This private cloud also carries data traffic used by agents in connection with servicing client calls, as well as general data traffic such as email. In some of its international sites where the carrier does not offer private cloud services, the Group has opted for dedicated leased lines connecting its facilities directly to its US data centres. The Group has backed up its private cloud/leased line arrangements described above with dedicated internet access at each site as well as at the data centres for emergency use. It has also connected each of its two data centres to each other through a high capacity leased line. The Group uses CenturyLink Inc, the third largest telecommunications carrier in the US, for its private cloud services connecting its data centres to its facilities for both voice and data traffic. Its total capacity used for its private cloud services is two OC-3 circuits (one at each data centres) corresponding to 310 Mb/s, with capacity to carry up to 5,000 simultaneous voice and data calls. On the client access side, the Group has leased telecommunications lines from Verizon, Centurylink and Windstream with a total capacity to carry approximately 10,000 simultaneous incoming and outgoing calls to and from its clients. The Group primarily uses an Avaya S-8700 PBX for its inbound calls, which is the market standard for large-scale enterprise contact centre applications. This PBX is split between both the Group’s data centres so as to prevent dependency on one data centre for effective operation of the PBX. The Group also uses an Asterisk-based PBX for a small portion of its inbound client calls as well as for internal corporate telephony. For its outbound traffic, the Group uses predictive dialers from a variety of software vendors and based upon hardware provided by Dialogix. For its application and database servers, the Group uses hardware provided by Dell, Hewlett Packard and EMC Corporation. The Group adheres to high standards of data security, and in particular those required by financial services related clients. All client data is housed within its secure data centres in the US, which comply with safe harbour standards imposed by non-US clients. The Group maintains ISO-27001 standards in its data security processes and has been certified as compliant with the standards laid down by the Payment Card Industry (PCI) for the handling of credit card transactions. Software The Group employs a 65-person software development team at its facilities in Pakistan. This team allows the Group not only to target a high quality of scripting and reporting capabilities (required by all outsourced contact centre clients) but also to develop customised software solutions for both client and internal uses. 18 The Directors believe that this latter capability places the Group at an advantage compared to many of its competitors, many of whom have limited custom software development capabilities. The Group’s internally developed software consists of two types – (a) large-scale development efforts for key contact centre applications, and (b) tactical tools developed to address specific client requests. Within the first category, the Group has developed its own integrated reporting system called IBEX Insight, its own recruitment management system called RMS, its own Interactive Voice Response platform called IBEX IVR and its own workforce management system called IBEX Force. By developing these applications, the Group has been able to avoid the expense of third party software licenses. Within the second category, the Group has developed several software tools ranging from an Agent Whisper system (which provides agents with advance indication of the type of incoming call – developed for one of its telecommunications clients) to an auto-login tool (developed for another client) that reduces agent log-in time by avoiding timeconsuming manual log-ins to many client applications. The Group also has an unlimited and perpetual right of use to several key software applications developed by its principal shareholder TRGI. These applications include the Group’s core Enterprise Resource Planning system called BPO Suite that provides combined human resources, payroll, procurement and operations reporting and integrated into the Group’s financial systems. These applications also include a network voice recorder (NVR), a CRM application, dialer software and the Group’s Asterisk based PBX software. These applications, if procured from outside vendors, are estimated to cost approximately $5,000 per seat in capital expenditures as well as on-going maintenance costs. The Group has a dedicated team responsible for maintaining and customising these key applications. IBEX also provides its clients with the option of enhancing their contact centre performance through SATMAP, a technology provided by a company majority owned by TRGI. SATMAP uses artificial intelligence and statistical pattern recognition technology to identify pairings between callers and agents most likely to result in high performance. SATMAP then interfaces with IBEX's underlying telephony to assign calls to agents in real time to enhance call outcomes. IBEX served as a launch customer for SATMAP in 2009 and has extensive SATMAP deployment experience. Intellectual Property The Group’s intellectual property is in the form of internally developed software (as referred to above), algorithms (supporting the above underlying software) and client databases. The Group protects its intellectual property through a variety of methods including copyright and contractual obligations. Confidential information and trade secrets, including details of algorithms and databases and sensitive information about customers, are protected by proprietary information and invention agreements and nondisclosure agreements entered into by the Group and its employees and contractors. Confidential information is also protected by non-disclosure agreements entered into by the Group and its partners and through the terms and conditions of its contractual agreements with its clients. IBEX has to date chosen to develop its intellectual property as trade secrets rather than as patents. The Directors believe that this choice avoids the expense of pursuing a patent portfolio, the public disclosure of which may reduce the Group’s competitive advantage. In addition, the Directors hold the view that policing the use of patents among competitors is not a productive use of capital or time in a servicesoriented business. The Directors believe that the Group’s trade secrets and other intellectual property are an important source of value and vigorously seek to expand and protect those intellectual property assets. 8. Clients The Group currently has over 70 client relationships. In FY 2012, the Group’s five largest customers, each of which are on the Fortune 500 list, accounted for approximately 74 per cent. of the Group’s revenues. Clients from the telecommunications industry made up over 50 per cent. of the Group’s revenues while the technology industry made up a further 28 per cent. 91 per cent. of the Group’s revenue in FY 2012 was sourced from clients based in the United States with the remainder attributable to clients in Canada, the United Kingdom, Pakistan and Senegal. 19 Profiles of some of the clients currently serviced by the Group are provided below: Technical support – technology industry The client is one of the leading technology companies in the world. The Group provides technical support for North American callers that need to troubleshoot issues associated with devices manufactured by the client. Most of the calls received by the Group are within the “Level 1” category representing calls of moderate technical complexity. The Group also now provides an increasing number of “Level 2” support for calls that represent an increased degree of technical complexity that Level 1 support is unable to resolve. 80 per cent. of all calls for this client handled by the Group are within the Level 1 category and agents undergo a minimum of four weeks of training before dealing with inbound calls. The Group provides service delivery to this client from four centres located in the US. During the fourth quarter of FY 2013 the Group is undergoing significant growth in the number of agents servicing this client. The Group has provided services to this client since 2008. Inbound customer service & service – telecommunications industry The client is one of the top two telecommunications companies in the US. The Group provides customer service for the client’s wireline segment, supporting a range of products from traditional landline telephone service to its broadband offering. The customer service provided by the Group’s agents consists mainly of responding to billing queries and addressing other account questions such as moving or installation. An important component of the call is a cross-sale to a higher-value added service such as broadband where the client continues to make significant investments in its network footprint. The Group provides service delivery from eight centres in the US and the Philippines. Agents undergo an extensive six to eight week training program for this client. The Group is in the process of ramping service delivery for this client as it diversifies service delivery for the broadband segment from additional locations. The Group has provided services to this client since 2004. Customer retention – cable/satellite industry This client is one of the largest cable/satellite service providers in the US. The Group provides customer retention services where agents receive calls from existing customers that intend to cancel service. The Group’s agents attempt to retain the customer by determining the reason for the intended cancellation, formulating a solution for the issue where possible and occasionally providing financial incentives for the customer to retain service. Once the customer confirms continuation of service, the agents also cross-sell other services offered by the client. The Group’s delivery location for this client is in the US. Agents on this program undergo ten weeks of training, given the critical nature of service to the end client. The Group has provided services to this client since 2012. Outbound customer acquisition – hospitality industry The client generates approximately $2 billion in revenue per annum and is a global leader in loyalty management, managing several leading frequent flyer programs as well as building and managing customised loyalty programs for its customers. The Group provides outbound customer acquisition services for one of the client’s business units that offers membership services (such as identity theft protection products or travel discount packages) to Canadian consumers. The client has formed partnerships with Canadian financial institutions where it markets the above membership services products to customers of those financial institutions. The Group’s agents make outbound calls to these customers to market the client’s membership services products. The Group provides customer acquisition services for this program from its centres in the Philippines, US and in Senegal (for French language services in Canada) and is the exclusive provider of such services for its financial institution partners. The Group has provided services to this client since 2002. 20 Inbound customer service – financial services industry The client is one of the leading providers of pre-paid debit cards and corporate payroll cards aimed at the under-banked consumer segment in the US. The Group provides customer service to customers of the client that are inquiring about their balance or about the fee structure related to the card. The Group provides customer service for this client from the Philippines. The program has stringent data security requirements given that agents are handling debit card information. This company has been a client of the Group since 2011. Managed services – online game services industry The client is one of the largest online game services providers in Europe. It has a substantial offshore operation providing back-office services such as accounting, fraud monitoring and other administrative services. During CY 2012, the Group negotiated a managed services arrangement with the client where it took over the management of the client’s Manila operation in exchange for a management fee. While the staff continue to be employed by the client, the Group has become responsible for the day to day management of the operation. The Group’s responsibilities include the attainment of performance and cost objectives as well as the provision of all administrative services associated with the employment of people. This company has been a client of the Group since 2012. 9. Strategy The Group underwent a strategic shift in mid-2011 when its Directors decided to pursue growth opportunities aggressively and make underlying investments in such opportunities if required. Prior to 2011 the Group’s primary focus was on cost and cash efficiency, with additional revenue opportunities being realised if they did not place an undue cash and cost burden upon the Group. In so doing, the Group developed a low cost overhead structure that allowed it to realise an EBITDA margin of 5.6 per cent. on revenues of $86.6 million for FY10 and yet offer a diversified suite of services, albeit with limited experience of large-scale delivery. The change in strategy was driven by the need to create defensible competitive positions by developing strategic relationships with clients. To do so, IBEX needed to become a large-scale vendor that was well integrated into the client’s core delivery, rather than a niche player that was more susceptible to business cycle risks. In so doing, the Group would additionally realise the positive margin effect of larger scale, which would build upon the operating leverage of a cost effective overhead platform. The initial implementation of that growth strategy was a significant increase in the scale of the Group’s two largest clients, who offered significant growth potential at the time of the strategic shift. As a result, the Group’s revenues have increased by 47 per cent. for the first calendar quarter of 2013 against the comparable quarter in CY 2010. The Group aims to continue its push for growth, with the objective of attaining a top twenty position among global contact centre outsourcers by annual revenue within the next five years. The core strategies for achieving that growth are as follows: ● Grow existing clients, especially those outside the current top two clients, by targeting a high quality of service and thereby placing itself in a position of capitalising on available growth possibilities; ● Win new clients on a sustained basis, with the objective of winning one client each quarter; ● Expand into the European outsourced contact centre services market – with focus upon the United Kingdom and France, using as levers the Group’s current presence in Bristol and Senegal respectively; ● Continue the diversification into non-voice services, as initiated over the last twelve months; and ● Selective acquisitions that accelerate the Group’s exposure to a specific geographical or industry vertical. 21 Growth of existing client base The Group’s budget is built upon the expansion of its current client base, particularly outside its top two clients. Within the current client base, the Group has identified five clients (outside the top two clients) that regularly purchase outsourced contact centre services at a level of over 500 agents per vendor (equivalent to over $15 million per year). These key clients include the Group’s fourth largest client, which is a leading provider within the cable/satellite services industry; its largest outbound services client, which is a top twenty commercial bank in the US with over $80 billion in assets and a subsidiary of a leading global bank; and the Group’s largest client in the hospitality industry, which is one of the leading global loyalty management services providers. Within each of these clients, the Group’s current scale and scope of services is a small proportion of the client’s overall spend on outsourced contact centre services. The Group’s immediate focus is on providing consistent service delivery on its current base of business with these clients and exceeding their performance objectives. At the same time, the Group is aiming to deepen and broaden the extent of its relationships within these client organisations so that it is in a position to convert strong performance on its current business into an expansion of its offering. The Directors believe that the Company also has significant further expansion potential with its top two clients, both in terms of on-going expansion of its current business and broadening into new services areas and business units. Win new clients The Group primarily employs a direct sales method in soliciting new clients. The Group has a dedicated sales force that is responsible for identifying business development opportunities and pursuing and closing those opportunities. The Group hires sales executives not only for their overall business development approach and rigour but also for their knowledge and relationships within specific industries and verticals. New clients tend to start service at a relatively small scale and grow their presence depending on performance. This pattern generally applies both to smaller clients as well as large, Fortune 100 clients. Consequently, the Group places significant emphasis on the launch process with a new client and invests in up-front arrangements related to client on-boarding. To meet its growth objectives, the Group aims to add one new client every quarter with enterprise potential. Expansion into new geographies The Group intends to diversify its client base beyond its current US base. The two geographies it intends to focus on are Canada and Western Europe (particularly the United Kingdom and France). The Group currently has a client base and/or service delivery capabilities associated with each of these geographies which makes the expansion relatively cost-efficient and without significant diversion of management bandwidth. The immediate focus of the Group relating to each of these geographies is to leverage its relationships with its current predominantly US client base in order to provide services they may require for their operations in Canada and Western Europe. The Group is already in detailed discussions with two existing clients in relation to their expansion in the United Kingdom (using the Group’s existing facility in Bristol) and in France (using the Group’s French language facility in Senegal). Diversification into non-voice services Most corporations that have significant contact centre operations increasingly need to offer non-voice customer facing services such as email support, live chat and website administration. In order to have a complete suite of customer-facing services, the Group has placed an emphasis on offering these services. Within the broader area of back office non-voice services, the Group has so far been opportunistic with contractual relationships established with two clients that approached the Group on taking over portions of their back office functions. For these two clients, the Group now manages delivery at a combined scale of 500 agents. Given its successful experience in this area, the Group is in a position to initiate an organised non-voice business development function. However, the Group will focus on this area once it has achieved significant momentum in its primary areas of strategic focus in the voice-based contact centre services space. Acquisitions Where appropriate and on a selective basis, the Group may facilitate growth by opportunistically acquiring companies that have a geographic or industry vertical presence that the Group finds attractive. Although 22 the Group does not at this stage have specific acquisition targets identified, should the opportunity arise, the Directors would consider making such acquisitions where the IBEX model can be promptly and profitably deployed. 10. Financial Information and Current Trading In order to make a proper assessment of the results and financial position of the Group, investors should not rely solely on the summary information set out below but should read the whole of this document, including the financial information set out in Part 3 of this document. Provided below is summary audited consolidated historical financial information for the Group for the 3 years ended 30 June 2012 as well as the six months ended 31 December 2012 which have been extracted without material adjustment from Part 3 of this document, prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. Also presented below is (i) reviewed income statement data for the Group which has been extracted without material adjustment from the reviewed income statement for the quarter ended 31 March 2013 included in Part 3 of this document and (ii) reviewed balance sheet data of the Group as at 31 March 2013 which has been extracted without material adjustment from the reviewed balance sheet as at 31 March 2013 included in Part 3 of this document. The historical financial information retrospectively combines the entities forming the current Group structure as if the combination had been in effect since 1 July 2009. Year ended 30 June 2010 $’000’s Revenue Gross profit Operating profit/(loss) Net assets 86,620 ––––––––––– 16,658 ––––––––––– 654 ––––––––––– 21,955 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Year ended 30 June 2011 $’000’s 97,118 ––––––––––– 17,491 ––––––––––– (513) ––––––––––– 20,135 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Six months Three months Year ended ended ended 30 June 31 December 31 March 2012 2012 2013 $’000’s $’000’s $’000’s* 104,286 ––––––––––– 13,554 ––––––––––– (2,339) ––––––––––– 18,121 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 66,585 ––––––––––– 9,154 ––––––––––– 759 ––––––––––– 18,517 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35,433 ––––––––––– 6,191 ––––––––––– 1,443 ––––––––––– 6,443 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– * Unaudited results The Directors believe that these results are a reflection of the investment in growth undertaken over the previous 18 months. Trading for the period from 31 March 2013 to the date of this document is in line with management’s expectations. Consistent with the Group’s budget for FY 2013, there is significant continued growth underway in the Group’s top two clients, with large training programs taking place from March to July 2013. The Group is aiming to add additional margin to the baseline established in the first quarter of CY 2013 upon the completion of these training programs and in the second half of the CY. Overall, the Directors continue to see further sales growth opportunities within the current and target customer base and the Directors look forward to the rest of the financial year with optimism. 11. Board of Directors and Senior Management Zia Chishti – Non-executive Chairman Zia is the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of The Resource Group International. He represents TRGI’s 75 per cent. interest in the Company. Zia has served as the Chairman and CEO of Align Technology (NASDAQ: ALGN) which he led from inception to a more than $500 million public valuation. Zia has worked at Morgan Stanley and McKinsey and serves on multiple corporate and non profit boards. Zia is a graduate of Columbia University and earned an MBA from Stanford Graduate School of Business. 23 Stephen Kezirian – Chief Executive Officer Steve has over 17 years of management experience with a focus on customer operations. At Cantor Gaming he was responsible for the firm’s technology, sales and operations teams, helping drive the growth from a single-site operation into a multi-location, distributed operating environment. Previously, he served as the youngest VP/GM at Sprint Nextel, where he was responsible for all phone-based sales and sales support operations with a global workforce of over 5,000 in seven countries. Prior to that Steve also had managerial positions at Tickets.com, an internet focussed live event ticketing company. Steve has also served in various positions at Morgan Stanley, McKinsey and JH Whitney. Steve has a B.A. in Economics from Harvard University and an MBA from Harvard Business School. Karl Gabel – Chief Financial Officer Karl joined IBEX at the time of its acquisition of Telespectrum Worldwide, Inc. in 2004, where he was VP of Finance and was instrumental in the financial restructuring of Telespectrum Worldwide, Inc. prior to its sale. Karl has over 15 years of experience in the contact centre industry, commencing with his first role as Director of Revenue at Telespectrum in 1997. Karl has a B.S. in Accounting from Penn State University and MBA from St. Joseph’s University. Tim Kelly – Non-executive Director Tim Kelly is a non-executive director of the Company. Tim was most recently the President and Chief Executive of Network Solutions, an internet enablement provider service small businesses and consumers. Tim led the company through a period of growth and expanding profitability, and in November 2011, drove the successful sale of the company to Web.com. Prior to Network Solutions, Tim enjoyed a successful career at Sprint Nextel, as President of the Consumer Division and as Chief Marketing Officer. Tim was also President of Tickets.com, an Internet-focused live event ticketing company. Tim graduated from the University of Florida with a Bachelor's in Marketing, and earned his MBA from Nova Southeast University. Mohammed Khaishgi – Non-executive Director Mohammed is Chief Operating Officer of The Resource Group. He represents TRGI’s 75 per cent. interest in the Company. Prior to joining The Resource Group in 2003, Mohammed was a Senior Director at Align Technology, where he managed Align’s offshore contact centre and back office services operations. He was previously a Senior Investment Officer at the International Finance Corporation (private sector investment arm of the World Bank) where he was responsible for investments in the Asian telecommunications and technology sectors. Mohammed has a B.S. degree in Electrical Engineering from University of Engineering and Technology in Lahore, Pakistan, a B.A. degree in Philosophy, Politics and Economics from the University of Oxford where he was a Rhodes Scholar and an MBA from Harvard Business School. John Leone – Non-executive Director John Leone is a non-executive director of the Company. John Leone is the Managing Director of PineBridge Investments, an investor in TRGI. John works on sourcing, negotiating and executing private equity transactions in Europe, Latin America, the Middle East and Africa. Prior to this role, John was General Counsel of PineBridge Investments’ Emerging Markets Private Equity operations. Earlier in his career, John was an attorney at Kirkland & Ellis LLP where he focused on advising private equity clients. John earned a Juris Doctor, with High Honors, from The George Washington University Law School where he was a member of the Law Review, and a Bachelor of Arts, Magna Cum Laude, from the State University of New York at Binghamton. Senior Management Julie Casteel – Chief Sales and Marketing Officer Julie has responsibility for sales and marketing for the Group. Julie has over 25 years of experience in the BPO sector, most recently at Sitel where she oversaw their growth from $30 million in annual revenues to over $1.7 billion over the course of her 11 year tenure. Prior to joining Sitel, she was Senior Vice President of Global Integrated Sales at EDS responsible for multiline technology and business process outsourcing offerings. Julie has a B.S. degree in Biology from Texas A&M University. 24 Nadeem Elahi – Senior Vice President, International Operations Nadeem is responsible for international operations for the Group. Nadeem has over 20 years of experience in general management and business development. Nadeem joined IBEX in 2007, when he started Virtual World (which is now part of IBEX) and also took on responsibility for managing IBEX’s international contact centre operations provided from Pakistan. Prior to IBEX, Nadeem was a founder-member of TRG (IBEX’s controlling shareholder) and was responsible for its North American portfolio from 2002 to 2006. He was previously part of the Global Business Development Group at Terra Lycos and prior to that he co-founded FTA Direct Inc., a provider of internet-based, supply-chain solutions for the global textiles industry. Nadeem has a B.A. in Mathematics and Economics from Brown University and MBA from Harvard Business School. Brian Hiener – Vice President, Philippines Operations Brian joined the Group in 2011 as VP of Philippine Operations. Previously, Brian spent 23 years with Convergys Corporation, in numerous leadership roles spanning sales, care and back-office operational environments. Given his extensive experience within a global operating footprint, Brian managed the design, implementation and operations for several large telephony, mobility and cable roll-outs internationally for Convergys. Brian is based in Manila. Jimmy Holland – General Counsel and Chief Human Resources Officer Jimmy has significant experience in the contact centre industry and was previously General Counsel of TeleTech Holdings, a top 5 outsourced contact centre provider. Jimmy also has significant experience in private equity as well as in debt and equity transactions and restructurings during 23 years in private practice with large US law firms. He has counselled executive management and boards of directors on legal, fiduciary and governance matters. Jimmy has a B.S. (Mathematics) and an M.A. (English Literature) from Louisiana State University and a Juris Doctor from the Vanderbilt University School of Law. Vickie Leslie – Senior Vice President, Global Performance Support Vickie Leslie joined the Group in 2012 as Senior Vice President of Operations Support, and brings more than 24 years of management experience in sales, service, marketing, and operations. During her 12 years with Sprint Nextel, Vickie served in several leadership roles across Vendor Management, Marketing, and Operations Support, most recently managing the Quality, Customer Experience and Root Cause Analysis teams across 75 locations. Previously, Vickie spent 11 years at Idelman Telemarketing and APAC in a variety of positions including Director of Operations. Vickie earned her bachelor’s degree from Kansas State University. Greg Rajchel – Senior Vice President, North American Operations Greg brings more than 16 years of leadership experience within the BPO space. His understanding of the business helps to pro-actively maintain a solution focused environment and is a strong believer in the voice of the customer. Greg has been part of IBEX since the acquisition of Reese Teleservices, Inc. in 2004, where he worked for 7 years holding various leadership positions in operations and client management. Greg has an Associate’s Degree in Business Administration from Butler Community College. 12. Employees The Group’s corporate headquarters are in Washington, DC., US. The Group employs approximately 3,750 people in the US, comprising primarily of agents located in the Group’s eight US contact centre facilities in the states of Tennessee, Virginia, Oregon, West Virginia and Pennsylvania. The Group employs 2,100 people in the Philippines at its three facilities; these employees do not include the 430 people employed by the Group’s managed services client. In Pakistan, the Group employs over 1,600 staff, divided between employees of Virtual World (Pvt) Ltd which provides services to domestic clients in Pakistan, and the remainder dedicated to the Group’s international operations. The Group employs 400 people in Senegal and 50 in the United Kingdom. 13. Corporate Governance The Directors recognise the importance of sound corporate governance and confirm that, following Admission, they intend to comply with the Corporate Governance Guidelines (as devised by the QCA in consultation with a number of significant institutional small company investors), to the extent appropriate 25 for a company of its nature and size. The Board also proposes to follow, as far as practicable, the recommendations on corporate governance of the QCA for companies with shares traded on AIM. This approach to corporate governance was proposed by the QCA as it considers the UK Corporate Governance Code to be inappropriate to many AIM companies. The Corporate Governance Guidelines state that, “The purpose of good corporate governance is to ensure that the company is managed in an efficient, effective and entrepreneurial manner for the benefit of all shareholders over the longer term.” Following Admission, the Board will meet at least four times per year to review, formulate and approve the Company group’s strategy, budgets, and corporate actions and oversee the Company’s progress towards its goals. It has established audit and remuneration committees with formally delegated duties and responsibilities and with written terms of reference. From time to time separate committees may be set up by the Board to consider specific issues when the need arises. Audit Committee The Board has established an audit committee with formally delegated duties and responsibilities. The audit committee will be chaired by John Leone and its other members are Mohammedulla Khaishgi and Tim Kelly. The audit committee will meet formally at least four times a year and otherwise as required. It will be responsible for ensuring that the financial performance of the Group is properly reported on and monitored, including reviews of the annual and interim accounts, results announcements, internal control systems and procedures and accounting policies, reviewing and monitoring the extent of the non-audit services undertaken by external auditors and advising on the appointment of external auditors. Remuneration Committee The remuneration committee will be chaired by Tim Kelly and its other members are Mohammedulla Khaishgi and John Leone. It is expected to meet at such times as required however not less than two times a year. Executive Directors may attend meetings at the committee’s invitation. The remuneration committee has responsibility for determining, within agreed terms of reference, the Group's policy on the remuneration packages of senior executives and specific remuneration packages for Executive Directors. This includes agreeing with the Board the framework for remuneration of the CEO, all other Executive Directors, the Company Secretary and such other members of the executive management of the Group as it is designated to consider. It is furthermore responsible for determining the total individual remuneration packages of each Director including, where appropriate, bonuses, incentives, pension rights and compensation payments. It is also responsible for making recommendations for grants of options under the Share Option Plans. The remuneration of Non-executive Directors is a matter for the Board. No Director may be involved in any discussions as to their own remuneration. From time to time the remuneration committee may consult with shareholders on remuneration matters, regardless of any regulatory requirement or governance guideline recommendation to do so. Nomination Committee The nomination committee will be an ad hoc committee constituted by the Board as and when required. When constituted it will be chaired by an independent member of the Board. It will have responsibility for reviewing the balance of the Board including its skills and experience, the state of the business and its leadership needs, and give full consideration to succession planning. It will also have responsibility for recommending new appointments to the Board. 14. Reasons for the Placing and Use of Proceeds The gross proceeds of the Placing receivable by the Group are expected to be approximately £10.7 million and are intended to be used for the retirement of existing debt. The Directors believe that Admission will assist IBEX in its development by (i) raising its profile in the sector, particularly internationally; (ii) providing investment to fund growth; (iii) increasing access to capital should further finance be required to expand the business of IBEX; and (iv) providing transparent incentives for existing and future management and employees. 26 Pursuant to the Placing: ● New Ordinary Shares will be placed with institutional investors, representing approximately 18 per cent. of the Enlarged Share capital and raising gross proceeds for the Group of £10.7 million (before expenses); and ● Sale Shares will be placed with institutional investors, representing approximately 7 per cent. of the Enlarged Share Capital and raising gross proceeds for TRGI of £3.8 million (before expenses). TRGI has agreed to enter into lock-in arrangements restricting its ability to sell or otherwise dispose of its shares, further details of which are set out in paragraph 12.3 of this Part 1. 15. Details of the Placing Liberum and Cenkos have entered into the Placing Agreement with the Company, the Directors and TRGI. Under the Placing Agreement, Liberum and Cenkos have conditionally agreed, as agents of the Company, to use their reasonable endeavours to procure subscribers for the New Ordinary Shares and, as agent of TRGI, purchasers for the Sale Shares, in each case at the Placing Price. The majority of the Placing Shares are being placed with institutional investors. Completion of the Placing is conditional, inter alia, on Admission taking placing on or before 28 June 2013 (or such later date as the Company, Liberum and Cenkos may agree), but in any event not later than 6.00 p.m. on 31 July 2013) and on the Placing Agreement becoming unconditional and not being terminated prior to Admission. The New Ordinary Shares will be issued credited as fully paid and the Sale Shares are fully paid. On Admission, the Placing Shares will rank pari passu in all respects with the Existing Ordinary Shares including the right to receive all dividends or other distributions declared, made or paid after Admission. The New Ordinary Shares to be issued by the Company pursuant to the Placing will represent approximately 18 per cent. of the Enlarged Share Capital and will raise approximately £10.7 million ($16.6 million) gross of expenses (approximately £9.1 million ($14.1 million) net of expenses) for the Company. The Placing Shares (being the aggregate of the New Ordinary Shares and the Sale Shares) will represent approximately 25 per cent. of the Enlarged Share Capital. At the Placing Price, the Company will have a market capitalisation of approximately £58.1 million. 16. Selling Shareholders TRGI has, pursuant to the terms of the Placing Agreement, agreed to sell the Sale Shares at the Placing Price, having provided customary warranties to Liberum and Cenkos in respect of title and its ability to sell the Sale Shares. Additional information regarding restrictions on dealing by TRGI is contained in paragraph 12.3 of this Part 1. 17. Dividend Policy The Board intends to implement a dividend policy in the financial year following Admission and pay cash dividends to Shareholders provided that the Company has sufficient distributable reserves and it is appropriate to do so. 18. Share Dealing Code The Company has adopted a share dealing code for Directors and key employees which the Directors believe appropriate for an AIM-quoted company. The Company will comply with Rule 21 of the AIM Rules for Companies relating to directors’ dealings and, in addition, will take all reasonable steps to ensure compliance by the Group’s applicable employees. 27 19. Incentive Arrangements The Company intends to attract, retain and incentivise key employees, officers and directors through the Share Option Plans. Details of the key terms of the Share Option Plans and the outstanding options granted under those plans are set out in paragraphs 4.1 and 4.2 of Part 4 of this document. 20. Lock-ins and Orderly Market Agreements Under the terms of the Lock-in and Orderly Market Agreements, each of the Directors have agreed not to dispose of any interest in any Ordinary Shares owned by them prior to the date which is 12 months from the date of Admission and, for a further 12 month period, only to dispose of their Ordinary Shares through Liberum or Cenkos during that period in such a way as to maintain an orderly market. In addition, TRGI has agreed not to dispose of any interest in Ordinary Shares owned by them prior to the date which is six months from the date of Admission and, for a further period of 18 months, only to dispose of their Ordinary Shares through Liberum or Cenkos during that period in such a way as to maintain an orderly market. Further details of these arrangements are set out in paragraph 12.3 of Part 4 of this document. 21. Admission, Settlement and Dealings Application has been made for the Ordinary Shares to be admitted to trading on AIM. It is expected that Admission will become effective and that dealings will commence in the Ordinary Shares on 28 June 2013. The Placing Shares have not been marketed in whole or in part to the public in conjunction with the application for Admission. No temporary documents of title will be issued. All documents sent by or to a Placee, or at his discretion, will be sent through the post at the Placee’s risk. Pending the despatch of definitive share certificates, instruments of transfer will be certified against the register of members of the Company. CREST is a paperless settlement system enabling securities to be evidenced otherwise than by certificate and transferred otherwise than by written instrument. The Directors have applied for the Ordinary Shares to be admitted to CREST with effect from Admission and CREST has agreed to such admission. Accordingly, the settlement of transactions in the Ordinary Shares following Admission may take place within CREST if individual Shareholders so wish. CREST is a voluntary system and holders of Ordinary Shares who wish to receive and retain share certificates will be able to do so. Where Placees have requested to receive their Ordinary Shares in certificated form, share certificates will be despatched by first class post within 14 days of the date of Admission. 22. Taxation Tax Information regarding UK taxation with regard to certain holders of the Ordinary Shares is set out in paragraph 18 of Part 4 of this document. That information is intended only as a general guide to the current tax position under UK law. If you are in any doubt as to your tax position, you should contact your independent professional adviser Tax Indemnity The Company undertook the Reorganisation, and as a consequence, IBEX Inc. has entered into an indemnification agreement with TRG Holdings, LLC and TRGI whereby TRG Holdings, LLC and TRGI indemnify IBEX Inc., the Company and IBEX Global Europe S.a r.l in respect of certain taxes (i) relating to the Reorganisation and (ii) measured by or imposed on net income attributable to the period prior to 31 March 2013 or the period after 31 March 2013 as a result of having been a member of the same tax group as TRG Holdings. Further details of these arrangements are set out in paragraph 12.8 of Part 4 of this document and the attention of investors is drawn to Part 2 of this document which provides further information on the tax risks faced by the Group. 28 23. Relationship Agreement Immediately following Admission, TRGI will be entitled to exercise or control the exercise of voting rights in respect of approximately 75 per cent. of the Enlarged Share Capital and will have the ability to exercise a controlling influence on the business of the Company and may cause or take actions that are not in, or may conflict with, the best interests of the Company or its Shareholders as a whole. Accordingly, the Company, Liberum, Cenkos and TRGI have entered into a relationship agreement which regulates the relationship between TRGI and the Company and ensures that the Company is capable of carrying on its business at arm’s length from TRGI. The principal terms of the relationship agreement are summarised in paragraph 12.6 of Part 4 of this Document. 24. City Code The Company is not expected to be subject to the City Code at Admission, as its place of central management and control is based in the USA and its securities are not traded on any regulated market. As a result certain protections that are afforded to shareholders under the City Code, for example in relation to a takeover of a company or certain stake-holding activities by shareholders, do not apply to the Company at Admission. With effect from 30 September 2013, this residency test will no longer apply to companies which have their registered offices in the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and which have securities admitted to trading on a multilateral trading facility (such as AIM) in the UK. This will have the effect of bringing the Company within the ambit of the City Code even though its place of central management and control was outside the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man. However, certain protections have been incorporated into the Articles to protect the shareholders in the period prior to 30 September 2013 which mirror the provisions of Rule 9 of the City Code (“Relevant Code Provisions”) to the extent that it is possible to do so. The Articles provide that an acquisition of shares that increased the aggregate holding of the acquirer and its concert parties to shares carrying 30 per cent. or more of the voting rights of the Company is prohibited. Similarly, any acquisition of shares by a person holding (together with its concert parties) shares carrying between 30 and 50 per cent. of the voting rights in the Company if the effect of such acquisition were to increase the person’s percentage of voting rights is also prohibited. The Board has, under the Articles, broad rights to sanction the relevant shareholder in respect of such acquisitions or to provide a cure for such breaches by Shareholder resolution. The main difference between these provisions and the Relevant Code Provisions is that the Panel does not have any jurisdiction to enforce these provisions, but as set out above this is due to change on 30 September 2013. Details of the key provisions of the Articles may be found in paragraph 6 of Part 4 of this document. 25. Related Party Transactions Pursuant to the Reorganisation, various related party agreements were entered into between TRGI and its associated companies and various members of the Group, with a view to underlining the Group's independence from TRGI. Details of such agreements are set out in paragraph 14 of Part 4 of this document. 26. Further Information Your attention is drawn to Parts 2 to 4 of this document that provide additional information on the Group and the markets in which it operates. You are advised to read the whole of this document and in particular, the attention of prospective investors is drawn to Part 2 of this document that contains a summary of the risk factors relating to an investment in the Company. 29 PART 2 RISK FACTORS An investment in Ordinary Shares involves a high degree of risk. Accordingly, prospective investors should carefully consider the specific risks set out below in addition to all of the other information set out in this document before investing in Ordinary Shares. The investment offered in this document may not be suitable for all of its recipients. Potential investors are accordingly advised to consult a professional adviser authorised under FSMA who specialises in advising on the acquisition of shares and other securities before making any investment decision. A prospective investor should consider carefully whether an investment in the Group is suitable in the light of his or her personal circumstances and the financial resources available to him or her. The Directors believe the following risks to be the most significant for potential investors. However, the risks listed do not necessarily comprise all those associated with an investment in the Group and are not set out in any particular order of priority. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to the Directors or which the Directors currently deem immaterial may also have an adverse effect on the Group and the information set out below does not purport to be an exhaustive summary of the risks affecting the Group. In particular, the Group’s performance may be affected by changes in market or economic conditions and in legal, regulatory and tax requirements. If any of the following risks were to materialise, the Group’s business, financial condition, results or future operations could be materially adversely affected. In such cases, the market price of the Group’s shares could decline and an investor may lose part or all of his or her investment. Risks specific to the Group The Group has a relatively short operating history and operates in an evolving market While some of the predecessor companies of the Group have been in existence for longer periods of time, the Group began commercial operations as a combined entity in 2006. The Group therefore has a comparatively short operating history which makes an evaluation of the Group’s business and prospects difficult. The Group cannot be certain that its business strategy will be successful or that it will successfully address these or other risks that may become material. The Group’s failure to address any of the risks described here could have an adverse effect on its business. Client concentration The Group’s business relies on relationships with a limited number of clients and any deterioration of the Group’s relationship with any particular client could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s performance. Contractual liability Not all the customer agreements that the Group has entered into contain limitation of liability or exclusion clauses in its favour. In addition, certain customer agreements render the Group liable and responsible for all acts of its appointed retailer agents. There is an obvious risk that any litigation or other claims under such agreements could result in significant financial detriment to the Group. Volume fluctuations from clients Many of the Group’s clients have no minimum volume commitments and could therefore deliver calls well under the level required to profitably utilise their dedicated group of agents. Even where minimum volume commitments do exist, the penalties triggered by any under-delivery of call volume may not make up for the loss in profitability resulting from such an under-delivery. The Group could therefore be adversely affected from any fluctuations in delivered call volume from its clients. 30 Reliance on the facility from CapitalSource Bank The Group has the benefit of, and is reliant upon, a revolving credit and security facility from CapitalSource Bank. The facility is an “asset based” credit facility which means that the loans are advanced from time to time based on whether or not there are sufficient eligible assets under the borrowing base to support advances made under the facility. Therefore there is a risk that if the Group does not have sufficient assets under the borrowing base to support such advances, the bank will not honour the requests for such advances. Tax Prior to the Reorganisation, IBEX Inc. was, among other entities, included in TRG Holdings, LLC’s consolidated federal income tax returns and certain state tax returns. As part of this arrangement, IBEX Inc. paid the amount of its attributable corporate income tax (if any) to TRG Holdings, LLC. Whilst the Group has no reason to believe that any member of the TRG Holdings, LLC tax consolidated group underreported or inaccurately reported matters that could affect the consolidated tax returns, there is a risk that a state or federal taxing authority could pursue any member of TRG Holdings, LLC’s tax consolidated group for unpaid tax liabilities and, as such, IBEX could be held jointly and severally liable for any unpaid tax liabilities, as determined by the IRS, pursuant to the law related to consolidated tax filings, irrespective of whether such tax liability was the primary responsibility of IBEX or another company in TRG Holdings, LLC’s historic tax consolidated group. In addition, the Reorganisation has been structured as a tax-free spin-off and TRGI has received a legal opinion that the Reorganisation should constitute a tax free spin off under Section 355 of the US Inland Revenue Code. However, a successful challenge against the tax-free status of this may result in a tax claim falling upon TRG Holdings, LLC and therefore indirectly on IBEX under the joint and several liability that comes with being part of a consolidated tax group. The Reorganisation resulted in the Group being comprised of an international group of companies and contractual relationships which the Directors believe will provide a tax efficient structure for the Group going forward. There is a risk that a tax authority in one or more of the jurisdictions in which the Group conducts its business may deem that taxes are payable above those declared and anticipated by the Group. Such unpaid tax liabilities would have the effect of increasing the effective tax rate of the Group and may have a material adverse effect on the financial position of the Company. IBEX has, however, entered into an indemnity agreement which provides, amongst other things, that TRG Holdings, LLC and TRGI will indemnify the Group from and against claims for unpaid corporate income taxes from federal and certain state taxing authorities up to the date of the Reorganisation. The tax indemnity also covers any tax incurred in the Reorganisation. In the event that a state or federal taxing authority were to pursue the Group for unpaid tax liabilities, and that TRGI were unable or unwilling to satisfy such liabilities pursuant to the Indemnity Agreement, the Group would remain liable for these unpaid tax liabilities which could have a material adverse effect on the financial position of the Group. In settling unpaid tax liabilities, TRG Holdings, LLC or TRGI, may choose to use accrued net operating losses from within the tax consolidated group to offset the tax liability. Such utilisation of net operating losses may impact on the net operating losses available to the Group going forward to offset against its own taxable profits and hence increase the effective tax rate of the Group. As security for TRGI's obligations under the indemnity agreement, TRGI has entered into a negative pledge and lock-in deed with the Company and IBEX Inc. which is described in paragraph 12.9 of Part 4 of this document. IBEX expects to benefit from an overall effective tax rate of 7 per cent. following Admission as a result of the Reorganisation. There is a risk that amounts paid or received under intra-group arrangements in the past or in the future could be deemed for tax purposes to be lower or higher, as the case may be, or be disregarded for the purposes of calculating tax which may increase the Group’s taxable income or decrease the amount of relief available to the Group with a consequential material negative effect on its financial and operating results. 31 Controlling shareholder Following Admission, approximately 75 per cent. of the Enlarged Share Capital will be held by TRGI. Notwithstanding the Relationship Agreement between TRGI and the Company, described in more detail in paragraph 12.6 of Part 4 of this document, TRGI will, therefore, be able to exercise significant influence over the Company’s corporate actions and activities and the outcome in general of matters pertaining to the Group, including the appointment of the Company’s board of directors and the approval of significant change of control transactions. Dependence on key executives and personnel The Group’s development and prospects are dependent upon the continued services and performance of its Directors, senior management and other key personnel. The loss of the services of any of the Directors, senior management or key personnel or a substantial number of talented employees or key consultants, could cause disruption or the loss of experience, skills or customer relationships of such personnel, which could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business, financial condition and results of operations. The Group is heavily reliant on telecommunications systems The Group relies heavily on the efficient and uninterrupted operation of its computer and communications systems and those of third parties, including the Internet and its call centre communications infrastructure. The ability of clients to dispatch calls to the Group’s data centres and the Group to connect calls from its data centres to its contact centre staff affects the revenue and profitability of the Group and the attractiveness of its services. Any disruption of the such telecommunications systems generally or locally to the Group or any failure of current or new computer and communication systems could impact the Group’s business. The Group’s future business performance depends on the renewal and award of contracts The Group’s success depends on its ability to maintain relationships and renew contracts with existing clients and to attract new clients. A substantial portion of the Group’s future revenues will be directly or indirectly derived from existing clients as well as new contracts. The current contracts of the Group are not of a long term nature, therefore failure to renew or extend existing contracts or to gain new business may adversely affect the Group’s future. Terms and termination of contracts The Group’s contracts are typically of a short duration with the initial term of most material contracts falling within the next 12 months. Many of the contracts of the Group can be terminated on thirty days’ notice by the client and should any such contracts be terminated the Group would lose the benefit of the contract. The loss of a major client, which accounts for a significant amount of the Group’s business and revenue, may have a material impact on the Group’s revenue and profitability. In addition, certain contracts contain provisions enabling the client to unilaterally impose amendments to the terms and conditions upon which it does business with the Group. Any such amendments may adversely impact the Group’s revenue and profits. The Group’s future business performance depends on continuing client outsourcing The Group’s business is reliant on the outsourcing of at least some aspects of customer or technical support or customer acquisition by consumer and business facing companies. Historically such activities have been at least partially if not wholly outsourced to companies such as the Group. However, should a shift be made toward insourcing, this may have an impact on the Group’s revenue and profitability. Disruptive marketplace New disruptive changes in the marketplace could lead to alternative models of customer or technical support by consumer and business facing companies, such as web-based self-service. Unless the Group is able to lead change and/or adapt its model to such changes, any change in market practices for customer and technical support, on which the Group’s business depends, may have an impact on the Group’s revenue and profitability. 32 Technological risks The Group operates in an industry where competitive advantage is heavily dependent on technology and systems. It is possible that an increase in technological developments (including but not limited to its clients or competitors) may reduce the importance of the Group’s function in the market. Staying abreast of technological or systems changes may require substantial investment. The Group’s existing working practices, technology platforms, databases and know-how may become obsolete or may be superseded by new technologies or changes in customer requirements, which may have a material adverse impact on the Group’s performance. Intellectual property protection The Group has not applied for and does not intend to apply for any patent protection for its IBEX Insight or IBEX Force proprietary technologies. Any failure to protect the Group’s intellectual property may result in another party copying or otherwise obtaining and using its proprietary technology without authorisation. Although the Group seeks to control the maintenance, development and use of its intellectual property including know-how via its employment and client contracts and other working practices, there can be no certainty that such measures will always prove sufficient to preserve the integrity of the Group’s intellectual property. There may not be adequate protection for the intellectual property in every country in which the Group’s services are made available or in which its technology is developed and deployed and policing unauthorised use of proprietary information is difficult and expensive. Due to the Group’s size and limited cash resources, it may not be able to detect and prevent infringement of its intellectual property. Any misappropriation of the Group’s intellectual property could have a negative impact on the Group’s business and its operating results. Furthermore, the Group may need to take legal action to enforce its intellectual property, to protect trade secrets or to determine the validity or scope of the proprietary rights of others. Litigation relating to the Group’s intellectual property, whether instigated by the Group to protect its rights or arising out of alleged infringement of third party rights, may result in substantial costs and the diversion of resources and management attention and there can be no guarantees as to the outcome of any such litigation. Such costs and diversion could materially and adversely impact the Group’s profitable operation. The Group may face online security breaches including hacking and vandalism The Group relies on encryption and authentication technology to provide the security necessary to effect the secure transmission of information such as personal data, credit or debit card numbers, from end customers to its clients, as well as in the continual development of its technology platform, including algorithms, databases and processes, across multiple locations. The Group cannot guarantee absolute protection against unauthorised attempts to access its IT systems, including malicious third party applications that may interfere with or exploit security flaws in its products and services. Viruses, worms and other malicious software programs could, among other things, jeopardise the security of information stored in a client customer’s computer or in the Group’s computer systems or attempt to change the internet experience of client customers by interfering with the Group’s ability to connect with them. If any compromise in the Group’s security measures were to occur and the Group’s efforts to combat this breach are unsuccessful, the Group’s reputation may be harmed leading to an adverse effect on the Group’s financial condition and future prospects. The Group also processes personal data (some of which may be sensitive) as part of its business. There is a risk that such data could become public if there were a security breach in respect of such data and, if one were to occur, the Group could face liability under data protection laws and lose the goodwill of its clients and /or prospective or existing client customers, which may have an adverse effect on the Group’s financial condition and future prospects. The Group may be affected by an increase in governmental regulation of calling practices The application or modification of existing laws or regulations, or adoption of new laws and regulations relating to the manner in which companies engage with their clients, especially in the area of customer acquisition over the telephone, could adversely affect the manner in which the Group currently conducts its outbound calling business. The law continues to tighten in terms of the manner in which marketers can reach out to prospective customers, with variants of a “Do Not Call” law being adopted in multiple 33 jurisdictions. The law is also evolving in relation to what data may be retained by the Group in relation to users interaction with the Group’s advertising, websites and call centres. Such changes in the law could adversely effect the Group’s financial condition and future prospects. Operations in international markets As the Group has some of its operations in overseas territories, the Group has and expects to become increasingly subject to diverse local legal and regulatory requirements. Violations of these laws and regulations could result in fines and/or criminal sanctions against the Group, its officers and employees, as well as challenges to its ability to conduct its business and its ability to offer products and services in one or more countries. Such challenges could delay or prevent potential acquisitions and materially damage the Group’s reputation, brand, international expansion efforts, ability to attract and retain employees and operating results. The Group’s success depends, in part, on its ability to anticipate these risks and manage these difficulties. The Group is also subject to a variety of other risks and challenges in operating in various countries, including but not limited to: challenges caused by distance, language and cultural differences; general economic conditions in each country or region; fluctuations in currency exchange rates; regulatory changes; political unrest, terrorism and the potential for other hostilities; longer payment cycles and difficulties in collecting debts; overlapping tax regimes; the ability to repatriate funds held by international subsidiaries at favourable tax rates; difficulties in transferring funds from certain countries; and reduced protection for intellectual property rights in some countries. If the Group is unable to manage the international aspects of its business, its operating results and overall business may be significantly and adversely affected. Expansion into new geographic markets The Group’s future growth will be dependent on its ability to generate business in additional geographical markets. Whilst the Directors believe that geographical expansion will prove rewarding, there is no guarantee that the Group will be able to generate the required level of sales or profitability if the costs of entry into and operating in these new geographical areas prove to be higher than expected. Other anticipated barriers to entry include language and the legal and regulatory regimes of the geography concerned. There is also no guarantee that expansion into additional geographical markets will not cause disruption and harm to the Group’s existing business. Expansion into new vertical markets The Group’s future growth will also be dependent on its ability to generate business in additional industry sectors or vertical markets. Whilst the Directors believe that such expansion will prove rewarding, there is no guarantee that the Group will be able to generate the required level of sales or profitability if the costs of entry into and operation in these new vertical markets prove to be higher than expected. Notwithstanding the experience of senior and other members of the management team in other sectors beyond the core US telecommunications, technology and media industries, the Group’s strategy of diversification into additional sectors, including energy, utilities, financial services and other consumer facing industries, could expose it to additional risks including but not limited to legal and regulatory risk, market or economic risk and tax related risk. If any unforeseen risk relating to expansion into new industry sectors were to materialise, or the Group’s ability to react to and manage any risk were to prove inadequate, the Group’s business, financial conditions, results or future operations could be materially adversely affected. There is also no guarantee that expansion into additional vertical markets will not cause disruption and harm to the Group’s existing business. Litigation Whilst the Group has taken, and the Group intends to continue to take, such precautions as it regards appropriate to avoid or minimise the likelihood of any legal proceedings or claims, or any resulting financial loss to the Group, the Directors cannot preclude the possibility of litigation being brought against the Group. 34 There can be no assurance that claimants in any litigation proceedings will not be able to devote substantially greater financial resources to any litigation proceedings or that the Group will prevail in any such litigation. Any litigation, whether or not determined in the Group’s favour or settled by the Group, may be costly and may divert the efforts and attention of the Group’s management and other personnel from normal business operations. Ability to recruit and retain skilled personnel The Company believes that it has appropriate incentive structures to attract and retain the calibre of employees necessary to ensure the efficient management and development of the Group. However, any difficulties encountered in hiring and retaining appropriate employees and the failure to do so may have a detrimental effect upon the trading performance of the Group. The ability to attract and retain new employees with the appropriate expertise and skills cannot be guaranteed. Exchange rate risk Exchange rate fluctuations could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s profitability or the price competitiveness of its products and services. There can be no guarantee that the Group would be able to compensate or hedge against such adverse effects and therefore negative exchange rate effects could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business and prospects, and its financial performance. Rapid growth In order to manage the further expansion of the Group’s business and the growth of its operations and personnel, the Group may need to expand and enhance its infrastructure and technology, and improve its operational and financial systems and procedures and controls from time to time in order to be able to match that expansion, as well as procure working capital financing. There can be no assurance that the Group’s current and planned personnel, infrastructure, systems, procedures and controls will be adequate to support its expanding operations in the future or that the Group will be able to source the working capital financing required for further growth. If the Group fails to manage its expansion effectively, its business, operations and prospects may be materially and adversely affected. Competition Current and potential competitors of the Group may have substantially greater financial, technical and marketing resources, longer operating histories, larger customer bases, greater name recognition and more established relationships than the Group and so may be better able to compete in the Group’s target markets. Dividends The payment of dividends by the Group is subject to it having sufficient distributable income and cash for such purpose, each of which will depend on the underlying profitability and cash generation of the Group. Directors and other key personnel The Directors and other key personnel have and may have in the future additional professional responsibilities and as such, may experience conflicts of interest and demands on their time to the possible detriment of the Group. General Market Risks Potential requirement for further investment Any future expansion, activity and/or business development may require additional capital, whether from equity or debt sources. There can be no guarantee that the necessary funds will be available on a timely basis, on favourable terms, or at all, or that such funds if raised, would be sufficient. If additional funds are raised by issuing equity securities, dilution to the then existing shareholdings may result. Debt funding may require assets of the Group to be secured in favour of the lender, which security may be exercised if the Group were to be unable to comply with the terms of the relevant debt facility agreement. The level and timing of future expenditure will depend on a number of factors, many of which are outside the Group’s 35 control. If the Group is not able to obtain additional capital on acceptable terms, or at all, it may be forced to curtail or abandon such planned expansion activity. Current operating results as an indication of future results The Group’s operating results may fluctuate significantly in the future due to a variety of factors, many of which are outside its control. Accordingly, investors should not rely on comparisons with the Group results to date as an indication of future performance. Factors that may affect the Group’s operating results include increased competition, an increased level of expenses, technological change necessitating additional capital expenditure, slower than expected sales and changes to the statutory and regulatory regime in which it operates. It is possible that, in the future, the Group’s operating results may fall below the expectations of market analysts or investors. If this occurs, the trading price of the Ordinary Shares may decline significantly. Transfer pricing There is a risk that amounts paid or received under intra-group arrangements in the past and/or the future could be deemed for tax purposes to be lower or higher, as the case may be, or be disregarded for the purposes of calculating tax which may increase the Group’s taxable income or decrease the amount of relief available to the Group with a consequential negative effect on its financial and operating results. Force Majeure The Group’s operations now or in the future may be adversely affected by risks outside the control of the Group including labour unrest, civil disorder, war, subversive activities or sabotage, fires, floods, explosions or other catastrophes, epidemics or quarantine restrictions. Taxation Statements in this document in relation to tax and concerning the taxation of investors in Ordinary Shares are based on current tax law and practice which is subject to change. The taxation of an investment in the Company depends on the specific circumstances of the relevant investor. Changes in tax laws or their interpretation could affect the Group’s financial condition or prospects. The nature and amount of tax which members of the Group expect to pay and the reliefs expected to be available to any member of the Group are each dependent upon a number of assumptions, any one of which may change and which would, if so changed, affect the nature and amount of tax payable and reliefs available. In particular, the nature and amount of tax payable is dependent on the availability of relief under tax treaties in a number of jurisdictions and is subject to changes to the tax laws or practice in any of the jurisdictions affecting the Group. Any limitation in the availability of relief under these treaties, any change in the terms of any such treaty or any changes in tax law, interpretation or practice could increase the amount of tax payable by the Group. AIM AIM securities are not admitted to the Official List. An investment in shares quoted on AIM may carry a higher risk than an investment in shares quoted on the Official List. AIM has been in existence since June 1995 but its future success and liquidity in the market for the Company’s securities cannot be guaranteed. AIM is a market designed primarily for emerging or smaller companies to which a higher investment risk tends to be attached rather than for larger or more established companies. A prospective investor should be aware of the risks of investing in such companies and should make the decision to invest only after careful consideration and, if appropriate, consultation with an independent financial adviser authorised under FSMA who specialises in advising on the acquisition of shares and other securities. Investment risk An investment in a share which is traded on AIM, such as the Ordinary Shares, may be difficult to realise and carries a high degree of risk. The ability of an investor to sell Ordinary Shares will depend on there being a willing buyer for them at an acceptable price. Consequently, it might be difficult for an investor to realise his/her investment in the Company and he/she may lose all of his/her investment. 36 Investors should be aware that, following Admission, the market price of the Ordinary Shares may be volatile and may go down as well as up and investors may therefore be unable to recover their original investment and could even lose their entire investment. This volatility could be attributable to various facts and events, including the availability of information for determining the market value of an investment in the Company, any regulatory or economic changes affecting the Group’s operations, variations in the Group’s operating results, developments in the Group’s business or its competitors, or changes in market sentiment towards the Ordinary Shares. In addition, the Group’s operating results and prospects from time to time may be below the expectations of market analysts and investors. Market conditions may affect the Ordinary Shares regardless of the Group’s operating performance or the overall performance of the sector in which the Group operates. Share market conditions are affected by many factors, including general economic outlook, movements in or outlook on interest rates and inflation rates, currency fluctuations, commodity prices, changes in investor sentiment towards particular market sectors and the demand for and supply of capital. Accordingly, the market price of the Ordinary Shares may not reflect the underlying value of the Group’s net assets, and the price at which investors may dispose of their Ordinary Shares at any point in time may be influenced by a number of factors, only some of which may pertain to the Group while others of which may be outside the Group’s control. If the Group’s revenues do not grow, or grow more slowly than anticipated, or if its operating or capital expenditures exceed expectations and cannot be adjusted sufficiently, the market price of its Ordinary Shares may decline. In addition, if the market for securities of companies in the same sector or the stock market in general experiences a loss in investor confidence or otherwise falls, the market price of the Ordinary Shares may fall for reasons unrelated to the Group’s business, results of operations or financial condition. Therefore, investors might be unable to resell their Ordinary Shares at or above the Placing Price. Illiquidity There will have been no public trading market for the Ordinary Shares prior to Admission. The Ordinary Shares may therefore be illiquid in the short to medium term and, accordingly, an investor may find it difficult to sell Ordinary Shares, either at all or at an acceptable price. Further, the Company can give no assurance that an active trading market for the Ordinary Shares will develop, or if such a market develops, that it will be sustained. If an active trading market does not develop or is not maintained, the liquidity and trading price of the Ordinary Shares could be adversely affected and investors may have difficulty selling their Ordinary Shares. The market price of the Ordinary Shares may drop below the Placing Price. Any investment in the Ordinary Shares should be viewed as a long term investment. 37 PART 3 HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP Introduction to the Historical Financial Information of the Group IBEX Global Solutions Plc IBEX Global Solutions Plc, (IBEX or the Company) was incorporated on 26 March 2013 as IBEX Global Solutions Limited and was re-registered as a public limited company on 4 June 2013. The Company is incorporated under the Companies Act 2006 with a financial year end of 30 June. No separate historical financial information is presented on the Company as it was incorporated outside of the period covered by the historical financial information. Refer to paragraph 11 of Part 4 for details on the formation of the IBEX Group on 29 March 2013. Entities included within the historical financial information The historical financial information for the three years and six months ended 31 December 2012, as presented in Part 3B includes the following material entities which were all held under common control by The Resource Group International Limited throughout the period of the historical financial information: ● TRG Customer Solutions Inc (trading as IBEX Global Solutions) ● TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc ● TRG Marketing Solutions Limited ● Virtual World (Private) Limited ● TRG Philippines Inc ● TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc The Resource Group International Limited will control the Group post the flotation. Basis of preparation As the formation of the Group occurred between entities under common control by The Resource Group International Limited, the historical financial information retrospectively combines the above entities for all periods presented (at carrying values) as if the combination had been in effect since the beginning of the first period presented being 1 July 2009. The historical financial information reports results of operations from 1 July 2009. Similarly, the historical financial information presents the combined statements of financial position as of the beginning of the period as though the assets and liabilities had been transferred at their carrying value at that date. 38 PART 3A ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED 30 JUNE 2012 AND SIX MONTHS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2012 The Directors IBEX Global Solutions Plc 1700 Pennsylvania Avenue NW, Suite 560 Washington DC CO 80104 24 June 2013 Dear Sirs IBEX Global Solutions Plc – Historical Financial Information for the three years ended 30 June 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 We report on the historical financial information of IBEX Global Solutions Plc and its subsidiary undertakings as set out in Part 3B which comprises the combined statements of comprehensive income, combined statements of financial position, combined statements of changes in equity, combined statements of cash flows and accompanying notes, for the three years and six months ended 31 December 2012. This historical financial information has been prepared for inclusion in the AIM Admission Document dated 24 June 2013 of IBEX Global Solutions PLC (the “Admission Document”) on the basis of preparation and under the accounting policies as set out in notes 2 and 3 to the historical financial information. This report is required by Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies and is given for the purpose of complying with that regulation and for no other purpose. Responsibilities Save for any responsibility arising under Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies to any person as and to the extent there provided, to the fullest extent permitted by law we do not assume any responsibility and will not accept any liability to any other person for any loss suffered by any such other person as a result of, arising out of, or in connection with this report or our statement, required by and given solely for the purposes of complying with Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies, consenting to the inclusion in the Admission Document. As described in note 2 of the historical financial information, the directors of IBEX Global Solutions Plc are responsible for preparing the historical financial information on the basis of preparation set out in note 2 to the historical financial information. It is our responsibility to form an opinion on the historical financial information as to whether the historical financial information gives a true and fair view, for the purposes of the Admission Document, and to report our opinion to you. Basis of opinion We conducted our work in accordance with the Standards for Investment Reporting issued by the Auditing Practices Board in the United Kingdom. Our work included an assessment of evidence relevant to the amounts and disclosures in the historical financial information. It also included an assessment of the significant estimates and judgements made by those responsible for the preparation of the historical financial information and whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the entity’s circumstances, consistently applied and adequately disclosed. We planned and performed our work so as to obtain all the information and explanations which we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the 39 historical financial information is free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or other irregularity or error. Opinion In our opinion, the historical financial information gives, for the purposes of the Admission Document, a true and fair view of the state of affairs of IBEX Global Solutions Plc and its subsidiaries as at 30 June 2010, 30 June 2011, 30 June 2012 and 31 December 2012 and of its profits, cash flows and changes in equity for the years ended 30 June 2010, 30 June 2011, 30 June 2012 and for the six month period ended 31 December 2012, in accordance with the basis of preparation set out in note 2 to the historical financial information. Declaration For the purposes of Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies we are responsible for this report as part of the Admission Document and declare that we have taken all reasonable care to ensure that the information contained in this report is, to the best of our knowledge, in accordance with the facts and contains no omission likely to affect its import. This declaration is included in the Admission Document in compliance with Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies. Yours faithfully GRANT THORNTON UK LLP 40 PART 3B HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED 30 JUNE 2012 AND SIX MONTHS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2012 Combined Statements of Comprehensive Income For the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 Notes Continuing operations Revenue Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Other income 4 22 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 86,620 (69,962) 97,118 (79,627) 104,286 (90,732) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 16,658 17,491 13,554 9,154 (16,154) 150 (18,004) – (15,895) 2 (8,395) – ––––––––––– Operating profit/(loss) Other (expenses)/income: Finance costs Gain on disposal of assets 26 33 Profit/(loss) before income taxes 23 Income tax expense 27 Net profit/(loss) from continuing operations Discontinued operations Income from discontinued operations, net of income taxes Total comprehensive income/(loss) attributable to equity holders ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (513) (2,339) 759 (1,908) 3,491 (1,977) 7 (1,700) – (931) – ––––––––––– 2,237 (450) ––––––––––– 29 ––––––––––– Net profit/(loss) Other comprehensive (loss)/income: Foreign currency translation adjustment ––––––––––– 654 1,787 32 66,585 (57,431) 1,816 (148) ––––––––––– 1,668 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,483) 279 ––––––––––– (4,039) (160) ––––––––––– (2,204) – ––––––––––– (4,199) – ––––––––––– (2,204) 89 ––––––––––– (2,115) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (4,199) (36) ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 41 (4,235) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (172) (63) ––––––––––– (235) – ––––––––––– (235) (61) ––––––––––– (296) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Financial Position As at 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012 Assets Goodwill Other intangible assets Property, plant and equipment Other non-current assets Deferred tax assets Total non current assets Current assets: Trade and other receivables Deferred expenses – current portion Due from affiliates Cash and cash equivalents Notes 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 5 6 7 8 27 8,644 1,014 5,827 2,356 18 8,644 742 4,145 1,955 – 9 28 10 Total current assets Equity and liabilities Share capital and reserves Share capital Additional paid in capital Other reserves Retained loss Total equity Non current liabilities: Deferred tax liabilities Deferred revenue – non-current portion Obligation under finance lease – non current portion Due to affiliates – non-current portion Retirement benefits obligations Other Total non current liabilities Current liabilities: Line of credit Obligation under finance lease – current portion Trade and other payables Deferred revenue – current portion Current income tax liabilities Due to affiliates – current portion ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 15,486 15,549 14,952 15,867 1,440 11,295 570 18,522 1,426 12,346 828 18,844 1,510 14,187 1,925 24,408 907 14,338 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 29,172 33,122 36,466 Total equity and liabilities ––––––––––– 48,608 ––––––––––– 52,015 ––––––––––– 42,107 ––––––––––– 57,059 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 37,508 173 (17,190) 1,464 37,557 508 (19,394) 1,464 39,621 629 (23,593) 1,464 40,271 610 (23,828) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 21,955 20,135 18,121 18,517 1,062 704 759 806 611 404 195 – 14 16 174 676 680 28 20 658 103 545 2,141 171 498 2,208 288 729 2,477 353 711 27 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,995 4,092 4,855 5,027 15 9,745 11,158 11,983 14,597 14 16 130 9,829 1,656 387 334 94 11,279 1,556 – 294 679 14,487 1,800 – 90 372 17,537 918 – 91 28 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 22,081 24,381 29,039 ––––––––––– Total liabilities 8,644 612 3,456 2,240 – 17,859 47,031 11 12 8,644 706 3,948 2,251 – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Total assets 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 25,076 ––––––––––– 47,031 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 28,473 ––––––––––– 48,608 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 33,894 ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 42 52,015 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 33,515 ––––––––––– 38,542 ––––––––––– 57,059 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Changes in Equity For the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 Issued, subscribed and paid-up capital $’000’s Balance as at 1 July 2009 Profit for the year Other comprehensive income Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 30 June 2010 Net loss Other comprehensive income Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 30 June 2011 Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 30 June 2012 Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the period Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 December 2012 1,464 – – Additional paid in capital $’000’s 31,020 – – Other reserves Foreign Employee currency share translation option plan reserve $’000’s $’000’s 711 – – (1,356) 295 Retained loss $’000’s Total equity $’000’s (18,563) 1,373 – 13,276 1,373 295 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 6,488 – – 295 – 1,373 – 1,668 6,488 – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 6,488 523 ––––––––––– 523 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – 37,508 – 1,234 – – – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,061) – 89 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 49 – – 89 – – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 49 246 ––––––––––– 246 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 37,557 – – 1,480 – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (972) – (36) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 2,064 – – (36) – – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 2,064 157 ––––––––––– 157 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 39,621 – – 1,637 – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,008) – (61) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 650 – – (61) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 650 ––––––––––– 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– 1,679 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,069) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 43 – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (17,190) (2,204) – ––––––––––– (2,204) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (19,394) (4,199) – ––––––––––– (4,199) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,593) (235) – ––––––––––– (235) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,828) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 523 ––––––––––– 7,011 ––––––––––– 21,955 (2,204) 89 ––––––––––– (2,115) 49 246 ––––––––––– 295 ––––––––––– 20,135 (4,199) (36) ––––––––––– (4,235) 2,064 157 ––––––––––– 2,221 ––––––––––– 18,121 (235) (61) ––––––––––– (296) 650 42 ––––––––––– 692 ––––––––––– 18,517 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Cashflows For the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 Notes Cash flows from operating activities: Cash (used in)/generated from operations 29 Interest paid Taxes paid 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s (4,942) (1,908) 231 2,146 (1,977) (628) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,504 (1,700) (457) ––––––––––– (647) (931) (151) ––––––––––– Net cash used in operating activities (6,619) (459) (653) (1,729) Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of property and equipment Additions to intangible assets Proceeds from sale of assets (1,798) (415) 5,328 (921) (313) – (463) (312) – (673) – – ––––––––––– Net cash generated from/(used in) investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Repayments under financial agreements Borrowings on line of credit Repayments on line of credit Grants received Capital contributions from parent undertaking Payments on capital lease obligations Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period (775) (673) (6,693) 9,745 – 674 – 1,413 – 627 – 11,983 (11,158) 514 – 2,614 – 57 – – 2,064 650 (159) (849) (303) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,393 1,881 2,554 3,018 94 70 (29) (87) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (17) 258 1,097 529 587 ––––––––––– 10 ––––––––––– (1,234) Net cash generated from financing activities Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period ––––––––––– 3,115 (333) Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents ––––––––––– 570 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 570 ––––––––––– 828 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 828 ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 44 1,925 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,925 ––––––––––– 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Notes to the Historical Financial Information 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012 (1) Nature of the business IBEX Global Solutions Plc, (IBEX or the Company) was incorporated on 26 March 2013 as IBEX Global Solutions Limited and was re-registered as a public limited company on 4 June 2013. The Company is incorporated under the Companies Act 2006 with a financial year end of 30 June. No separate historical financial information is presented on the Company as it was incorporated outside of the period covered by the historical financial information. Refer to Paragraph 11 of Part 4 for details on the formation of the IBEX Group on 29 March 2013. IBEX Group is a global portfolio of companies in the contact center and related business process outsourcing (BPO) business operating from the United States, Philippines, United Kingdom, Pakistan and Senegal. Service offerings include customer care support, business and consumer inbound and outbound telesales and technical support services. IBEX Group also offers enabling technology solutions including Interactive Voice Response (IVR). (2) Basis of preparation The combined historical financial information for the three years and six months ended 31 December 2012 has been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the AIM Rules and in accordance with this basis of preparation. The basis of preparation describes how the combined historical financial information has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union (IFRS as adopted by the EU) except as described below. As the formation of the Group occurred between entities under common control by The Resource Group International Limited throughout the period of the historical financial information, the historical financial information retrospectively combines the following material entities for all periods presented (at carrying values) as if the combination had been in effect since the beginning of the first period presented being 1 July 2009. ● TRG Customer Solutions Inc (trading as IBEX Global Solutions) ● TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc ● TRG Marketing Solutions Limited ● Virtual World (Private) Limited ● TRG Philippines Inc ● TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc The historical financial information reports results of operations from 1 July 2009. Similarly, the historical financial information presents the combined statements of financial position as of the beginning of the period as though the assets and liabilities had been transferred at their carrying value at that date. Financial statements and historical financial information presented for the prior period are also retrospectively adjusted to furnish comparative information. IFRS’s as adopted by the EU do not provide for the preparation of combined financial information when the Company does not control its subsidiaries during the period of the historical financial information and accordingly in preparing the combined historical financial information certain accounting conventions commonly used for the preparation of historical financial information for inclusion in investment circulars as described in the Annexure to SIR 2000 (Investment Reporting Standard applicable to public reporting engagements on historical financial information) issued by the UK Auditing Practices Board have been applied. In addition to the above departure the application of these conventions result in the following material 45 departures from IFRS’s as adopted by the EU. In other respects IFRS’s as adopted by the EU has been applied: – as the combined historical financial information has been prepared on a combined basis the Company is unable to measure earnings per share. Accordingly the requirement of IAS 33 –Earnings per Share – to disclose earnings per share, has not been complied with; and – the combined historical financial information does not constitute statutory accounts within the meaning of section 434 of Companies Act 2006 and is not a set of general purpose financial statements under paragraph three of IFRS 1 – First Time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards and consequently the Company does not make an explicit and unreserved statement of compliance with IFRS as adopted by the EU. A company is only permitted to apply the first-time adoption rules of IFRS 1 in its first set of financial statements where such a unreserved statement has been made. Although such a statement has not been made here, the combined historical financial information has been prepared as if the date of transition to IFRS was 1 June 2009, the beginning of the first period presented, and the requirements of IFRS has been applied since that date The Directors of the Company are responsible for preparation of this historical financial information. (3) Summary of significant accounting policies (a) Basis of combination All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated upon combination. The following subsidiaries of the Company have been excluded from combination on the grounds that they are immaterial to the Group: o IBEX Global Private Limited o The Resource Group Senegal SA (b) Basis of measurement This historical financial information has been prepared on the basis of the historical cost convention. (c) Functional and presentation currency Items included in the financial statements of each of the IBEX entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (‘the functional currency’). The functional currency for each entity included in the combined historical financial information is as follows: Entity Functional currency IBEX Inc. TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc TRG Marketing Solutions Limited Virtual World (Private) Limited TRG Philippines Inc/TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc United States Dollar Canadian Dollar Great Britain Pound Pakistan Rupee Philippine Peso The historical financial information is presented in United States Dollars, being the Group’s presentation currency. (d) Foreign currency translation The results and financial position of all the IBEX entities that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency of IBEX are translated into the presentation currency of the Group as follows: (i) assets and liabilities are translated at the closing exchange rate at the year end; (ii) income and expenses are translated at the average exchange rate; and (iii) all resulting exchange differences are recognised as a separate component of equity. 46 On combination, exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in a foreign subsidiary are taken to other comprehensive income. When a foreign subsidiary, branch or operation is sold, exchange differences that were recorded in equity are recognised in profit and loss in the combined statement of comprehensive income. (e) Foreign currency transactions Foreign currency transactions of the IBEX entities are translated into their respective functional currencies at the rates of exchange approximating to those prevailing on the date of transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities in foreign currencies are retranslated into their respective functional currencies at the rates of exchange approximating to those prevailing at each year end. Exchange gains and losses are included in the profit and loss within selling, general and administrative expenses. (f) Segment reporting The Group has one operating segment being the provision of contact center and related business process outsourcing services. The single operating segment has been identified on the basis of internal reports that are regularly reviewed by the Chief Operating Decision Maker to allocate resources and assess performance. Executive management, being the executive leadership team, are considered to be the Chief Operating Decision Makers. (g) Revenue recognition Revenue is measured at the fair value of consideration received or receivable excluding rebates, discount and related taxes. Revenue from call center services is recognised as the services are performed on the basis of the number of billable hours or other contractually agreed metrics. Revenue from inbound and outbound telephonic and internet based communication services that are customised to the customers’ needs is recognised at the contractual rates as services are provided. Revenue for the initial training that occurs upon commencement of a new client contract is deferred if that training is billed separately to a client. Training revenue is then amortised on a straight-line basis over the life of the client contract as it is not considered to have a standalone value to the customer. The related incremental direct expenses are deferred and charged to selling, general and administrative expenses on a straight line basis over the life of the client contact as the related revenue is recognised. These incremental direct expenses relate directly to each contract, generate or enhance resources that will be used in satisfying performance obligations in the future and are expected to be recovered in full. (h) Grants Government grants are recognised at fair value where there is a reasonable assurance that the grant will be received and the Group will comply with all attached conditions. Government grants relating to costs are recognised in profit or loss in the combined statements of comprehensive income over the period necessary to match the corresponding costs that are intended to be compensated. These are netted off against the relevant costs in the profit and loss. Government grants relating to property and equipment are deducted from the assets carrying value resulting in a lower depreciation charge over the life of the asset. (i) Goodwill Goodwill arising as a result of a business combination represents the excess of the cost of the business combination over the Group’s interest in the net fair value of identifiable assets and liabilities of the acquired business at the date of acquisition. Goodwill is initially recognised as an asset at cost and subsequently measured at cost less impairment in value, if any. 47 Goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis and also when there is an indication of impairment. Impairment losses on goodwill are not reversed. On disposal of an entity, the attributable amount of goodwill is included in the determination of the profit or loss on disposal. Goodwill is allocated to cash-generating units for the purpose of impairment testing. The allocation is made to those cash-generating units or groups of cash-generating units that are expected to benefit from the business combination in which the goodwill arose. (j) Intangible assets Software Software which can be separately identifiable is capitalised as an intangible asset at cost of acquisition and then amortised over their estimated useful life of 3 years on a straight line basis. Trademarks Trademarks considered as intangible assets are capitalised at cost of acquisition. Trademarks with an indefinite useful life are not amortised but are tested for impairment annually. Patents Patents are capitalised at cost of acquisition and amortised over their estimated useful life of 4 years on straight line basis. Intangible assets are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment in value, if any. Amortisation is included within depreciation and amortisation in cost of sales and selling and administrative expenses. Useful lives of intangible assets, other than goodwill, are reviewed at each year end and adjusted if the impact on amortisation is significant. Gains and losses on the disposal of intangible assets are taken to profit or loss in the combined statement of comprehensive income. Subsequent expenditure is capitalised only when it increases the future economic benefits embodied in the specific asset to which it relates. All other expenditure, including expenditure on internally generated intangible assets which do not meet the IAS 38 criteria as development costs, is recognised in profit or loss within the combined statement of comprehensive income as incurred. (k) Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are recorded at historical cost reduced by the value of grants received that are used to acquire the property, plant and equipment, where applicable. Depreciation and amortisation are provided using the straight line method over the estimated useful lives or the shorter of estimated useful life or lease term for leased property. 33% (or period of the lease if shorter) Leasehold improvements Furniture and fittings Computers, communication and office equipment Vehicles 20% 20% – 50% 20% Expenditures for maintenance, repairs and improvements that do not prolong the useful life of an asset are charged to operations as incurred. Additions and improvements that substantially extend the useful life of the asset are capitalised. Any tenant allowance received is recognised as deferred income or reduces the value of property and equipment. An item of property and equipment is derecognised upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected from its use or disposal. Gains and losses on disposals are determined by comparing the sale proceeds with the carrying amount of the relevant assets. These are recognised in the profit and loss. 48 (l) Assets subject to finance leases Leases of property, plant and equipment where the Group has substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Assets subject to finance lease are initially recorded at the lower of the present value of minimum lease payments under the lease agreements and the fair value of the leased assets. The related obligation under the lease less financial charges allocated to future periods is shown as a liability. Finance lease obligations are secured by the related assets held under finance leases. The financial charges are allocated to accounting periods in a manner so as to provide a constant periodic rate of charge on the outstanding liability. Depreciation on finance lease assets is provided on a straight line basis over the lesser of their estimated useful life or the lease term. (m) Operating leases Leases in which a significant portion of the risks and rewards of ownership are retained by the lessor are classified as operating leases. Payments made under operating leases (net of any incentives received from the lessor) are charged to the profit and loss on a straight line basis over the lease term. (n) Financial instruments Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognised at the time when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. Financial assets The Group considers its financial assets to comprise cash, deposits, loan notes and various other receivable balances that arise from its operations. Trade receivables, deposits, loan notes and other receivables that have fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market are classified as loans and receivables. Loans and receivables are initially recorded at fair value and subsequently at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method, less any impairment. Interest income is recognised by applying the effective interest rate, except for short-term receivables when the recognition of interest would be immaterial. The carrying amount of the financial asset is reduced by any impairment loss directly for all financial assets with the exception of trade receivables where the carrying amount is reduced through the use of an allowance account. When a trade receivable is considered uncollectable, it is written off against the allowance account. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are credited against the allowance account. Changes in the carrying amount of the allowance account are recognised in profit and loss within the combined statement of comprehensive income. If in a subsequent period the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed through profit and loss to the extent that the carrying amount of the financial asset at the date the impairment is reversed does not exceed what the amortised cost would have been had the impairment not been recognised. The Group derecognises a financial asset or a portion of financial asset when, and only when, the contractual rights to the cash flows from the assets expires; or it transfers the financial asset and substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership of the asset to another entity. If the Group neither transfers nor retains substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership and continues to control the asset, the Group recognises its retained interest in the asset and associated liability for amounts it may have to pay. If the Group retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a transferred financial asset, the Group continues to recognise the financial asset and also recognises a collateral borrowing for the proceeds received. Financial liabilities Financial liabilities and equity instruments are initially measured at fair value and are classified according to the substance of the contractual arrangement entered into. Financial liabilities are subsequently 49 measured at amortised cost. The Group’s financial liabilities comprise trade payables, borrowings and other payables balances that arise from its operations. They are classified as “financial liabilities measured at amortised cost”. Finance charges are accounted for on an accrual basis in profit or loss using the effective interest rate method and are added to the carrying amount of the investment to the extent that are not settled in the period in which they arise. The Group derecognises financial liabilities when the Group’s obligations are discharged, cancelled or they expire. (o) Impairment of non-financial assets The carrying amounts of the Group’s assets are reviewed at each year end to determine whether there is any indication of impairment loss. If any such indication exists, the asset’s recoverable amount is estimated in order to determine the extent of the impairment loss, if any. An impairment loss is recognised for the amount by which the assets carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an asset’s fair value less cost to sell and value in use. Impairment losses are charged to income statement. During the year ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012; no impairment was recorded. (p) Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash and cheques in hand and bank deposits available on demand. (q) Share capital Ordinary shares are classified as equity. Equity instruments issued are recorded at the proceeds received, net of direct issue costs. As this historical financial information is prepared on a combined basis, share capital is a combination of share capital as presented in each of the entities individual financial statements. Share capital in individual entities has been translated into the presentation currency at historical rate ruling at the date of the equity transaction. As such the share capital will not represent the share capital of the Company post completion of the transaction which will be solely that of the Company. (r) Additional paid in capital Additional paid in capital represents capital contributions by parent entities which are not part of the combined historical financial information. (s) Employee stock option plans The ultimate parent entity, The Resource Group International Limited, maintains Stock Option Plans (the Plans), which authorises the granting of stock options to employees of IBEX and TRGI, the previous parent of the entities included within this combined historical financial information. Although the options are exercisable in exchange for shares in TRGI and not each of the entities included within this historical financial information, each entity recognises an expense related to the Plan for those options granted to employees of each entity. Each entity recognises as an expense the services acquired over the vesting period and the corresponding increase in equity at the grant date fair value of the share options of The Resource Group International Limited. As of 4 June 2013, the Company has its own stock option plan with options granted to management over Ordinary Shares currently owned by TRGI. Any options of TRGI granted to management of the Company have been retired. (t) Retirement benefits The subsidiaries of the Company maintain their individual retirement benefit plans as follows: TRG Customer Solutions Inc maintains the defined contribution TRG 401(k) Plan (the Plan), formerly known as the TRG Customer Solutions, Inc. 401(k) Retirement Savings Plan. The Plan was amended effective 1 January 2010 to: (i) comply with Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act; (ii) 50 eliminate the hardship withdrawal provision; (iii) change the eligibility to make Elective Deferrals; (iv) change the Vesting Service to the Elapsed Time Method; and (v) rename the Plan to the TRG 401(k) Plan. The plan is a single employer plan including the affiliated companies: TRGiSky, Inc., TRG Holdings, LLC (“TRG”), TRG Field Solutions, Inc., TRG Satmap, Inc., Digital Globe Services, Inc. and Stratasoft, Inc. Employees who meet certain eligibility requirements, as defined, are able to contribute up to federal annual maximums. The Plan provides for company matching contributions of 25 per cent. of the first 6 per cent. of employee contributions to the Plan, which vests 25 per cent. per year over a four year period. The company contributions to the plan for the fiscal year ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 were $37,000, $31,000, $34,000 and $18,000 respectively. IBEX Philippines Inc. operates an unfunded defined benefit plan. Under the plan, pension costs are actuarially determined using the projected unit credit method. This method considers each period of service as giving rise to an additional unit of benefit entitlement and measures each unit separately to build up the final obligation. Gains or losses on the curtailment or settlement of pension benefits are recognised when the curtailment or settlement occurs. Actuarial gains and losses are recognised as income or expenses when the net cumulative unrecognised actuarial gains and losses for the retirement plan at the end of the previous reporting period exceeded 10 per cent. of the higher of the present value of the defined benefit obligation and the fair value of plan assets. These gains and losses are recognised over the expected average remaining working lives of the employees participating in the plan. Otherwise, the actuarial gain or loss is not recognised. When the benefits of the pension plan are improved, the portion of the increased benefit relating to past service by employees is recognised in the statement of comprehensive income on a straight line basis over the average period until the benefits become vested. To the extent that the benefits vest immediately, the expense is recognised immediately in profit or loss within the combined statement of comprehensive income. Virtual World (Private) Limited, Pakistan operates a defined contribution plan (i.e. recognised provident fund scheme) for all its permanent employees. Equal monthly contributions at the rate of 6.5 per cent. of the basic salary are made to Provident Fund (“the Fund”) both by the subsidiary and employees. The assets of the fund are held separately under the control of Trustees. Contributions made by the subsidiary are charged to profit or loss within the combined statement of comprehensive income. IBEX UK Limited operates the Axa Insurance Personal Pensions Scheme. This is a money purchase scheme under which the subsidiary makes contributions for some employees. (u) Taxation Current taxation The charge for current taxation is based on taxable income at the current rates of taxation of the respective countries of incorporation of the IBEX entities after taking into account applicable tax credits, rebates and exemptions available, if any. TRG Customer Solutions Inc files a combined US group return under TRG Holdings LLC. Other entities file standalone tax returns in their respective jurisdictions. Management periodically evaluates positions taken in tax returns with respect to situations in which applicable tax regulation is subject to interpretation. It establishes provisions where appropriate on the basis of amounts expected to be paid to the tax authorities. Deferred taxation Deferred tax is provided on all temporary differences at each year/period end, between the tax base of the assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial reporting purposes. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for all taxable temporary differences. Deferred tax assets are recognised for all deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses to the extent that it is probable that the deductible temporary differences will reverse in the future and sufficient taxable profits will be available against which the deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses can be utilised. However, deferred tax is not accounted for if it arises from initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction other than a business combination that at the time of the transaction affects neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss. 51 The carrying amount of all deferred tax assets is reviewed at each year/period end and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the deferred tax assets to be utilised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the period when the asset is realised or the liability is settled, based on the tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the date of statement of financial position. (v) Borrowing costs Borrowing costs relating to the acquisition, construction or production of a qualifying asset are recognised as part of the cost of that asset. All other borrowing costs are recognised as an expense in the period in which they are incurred. (w) Use of estimates and judgments The preparation of the historical financial information in conformity with IFRSs as adopted by the EU and subject to the departures set out in Note 2 basis of preparation, requires the use of certain critical estimates that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, revenues and expenses. It also requires management to exercise its judgment in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies. Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated and are based on historic experience and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Due to the inherent uncertainty involved in making those estimates, actual results reported in future periods could differ from those estimates. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognised in the period in which the estimates are revised and in any future periods affected. In the process of applying Group’s accounting policies, management has made the following estimates and judgments which are significant to the historical financial information: Recognition of training revenue and associated incremental direct expenses Management have considered a number of alternative options for the recognition of training revenue and associated incremental direct expenses and following this review they have concluded the following: – as training revenue does not have a standalone value to the customer it should be amortised on a straight line basis over the life the client contract; – as incremental direct expenses relate directly to each customer contract, generate or enhance resources that will be used in satisfying performance obligations in the future and are expected to be recovered in full they should be deferred and amortised on a straight line basis over the life of the client contract. Impairment of goodwill The calculation for considering the impairment of the carrying amount of goodwill requires a comparison of the present value of the cash-generating units to which goodwill has been allocated, to the value of goodwill and the associated assets in the balance sheet, The calculation of present value requires an estimate of the future cash flows expected to arise from the cash generating unit, the selection of a suitable discount rate and terminal value. The key assumptions made to relation to the impairment of goodwill are set out in Note 5. Staff retirement plans and other employee benefits The net defined benefit pension plan assets or liabilities are recognised in the Group balance sheet. The determination of the position requires assumptions to be made regarding inter alia future salary increases, mortality, discount rates and inflation. The key assumptions made in relation to the pension plans are set out Note 20. 52 Provision for taxation The US and Canadian entities are currently reported within consolidated tax filings of affiliated entities. Management have estimated the standalone tax position of these entities for inclusion in this financial information. The key assumptions made in relation to tax provisioning are set out in Note 27. Classification of the disposal of IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc Management consider the sale of the trade and assets of IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc in June 2010 to be that of a sale of a continuing foreign operation and as such has reclassified cumulative foreign exchange differences in the gain on the disposal in the profit and loss within the statement of comprehensive income. Further commentary is included within Note 33. (x) Standards, Interpretations and Amendments not yet effective The following standards, amendments and interpretations of approved accounting standards will be effective for accounting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013: IAS 19 Employee Benefits (amended 2011) – (effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013). The amended IAS 19 includes amendments that require actuarial gains and losses to be recognised immediately in other comprehensive income; this change will remove the corridor method and eliminate the ability for entities to recognise all changes in the defined benefit obligation and in plan assets in profit or loss, which currently is allowed under IAS 19; and that the expected return on plan assets recognised in profit or loss is calculated based on the rate used to discount the defined benefit obligation. The Group’s policy is to account for actuarial gains and losses using the corridor method and with the change unrecognised actuarial gains amounting to $133,515 at 30 June 2012 and 31 December 2012 would need to be recognised in other comprehensive income. IAS 27 Separate Financial Statements (2011) – (effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013). IAS 27 (2011) supersedes IAS 27 (2008). Three new standards IFRS 10 – Combined Financial Statements, IFRS 11 – Joint Arrangements and IFRS 12 – Disclosure of Interest in Other Entities dealing with IAS 27 would be applicable effective 1 January 2013. IAS 27 (2011) carries forward the existing accounting and disclosure requirements for separate financial statements, with some minor clarifications. The amendments have no impact on financial information of the Group. IAS 28 Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures (2011) – (effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013). IAS 28 (2011) supersedes IAS 28 (2008). IAS 28 (2011) makes the amendments to apply IFRS 5 to an investment, or a portion of an investment, in an associate or a joint venture that meets the criteria to be classified as held for sale; and on cessation of significant influence or joint control, even if an investment in an associate becomes an investment in a joint venture. The amendments have no impact on financial information of the Group. Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Amendments to IFRS 7) – (effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013). The amendments to IFRS 7 contain new disclosure requirements for financial assets and liabilities that are offset in the statement of financial position or subject to master netting agreement or similar arrangement. The introduction of these standards and interpretations is not expected to have a material effect on the historical financial information. 53 (4) Operating segments This historical financial information has been prepared of the basis of a single operating segment. Whilst the group operates in different locations, there are no multiple products or lines of services upon which the results reported to the chief operating decision maker are segregated and analysed. Revenue Gross margin Operating profit/(loss) US GAAP to IFRS adjustments Reportable operating profit/(loss) 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 86,620 16,658 625 29 97,118 17,491 (487) (26) 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 104,286 13,554 (2,385) 46 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 654 (513) (2,339) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 66,585 9,154 745 14 ––––––––––– 759 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 91.97 per cent., 91.30 per cent., 90.81 per cent. and 91.67 per cent. of the total revenue was earned from customers in the United States of America for the year ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 respectively. The following table summarises those non related party customers with revenue or accounts receivable in excess of 5 per cent. total revenue or total receivables for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012 respectively. The revenue analysis below does not form part of the Group’s segmental reporting but is provided voluntarily for those customers whose revenue is below 10 per cent. of Group revenue. 30 June 2010 Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $’000’s % $’000’s % Client 1 Client 2 Client 3 Client 4 Client 5 Other 32,822 15,212 11,862 4,033 1,918 38 18 14 5 2 5,439 1,184 1,138 877 1,918 37 8 8 6 13 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 65,847 20,773 77 23 10,556 4,064 72 28 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 86,620 100 14,620 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2011 Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $’000’s % $’000’s % Client 1 Client 2 Client 3 Client 4 Client 5 Other 14,092 18,119 10,311 5,915 27,106 14 19 11 6 28 2,501 1,450 771 559 5,599 16 9 5 3 35 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 75,543 21,575 78 22 10,880 5,311 68 32 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 97,118 100 16,191 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 54 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2012 Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $’000’s % $’000’s % Client 1 Client 2 Client 3 Client 5 Client 6 Other 11,295 26,335 17,023 16,818 5,911 11 25 16 16 6 – 4,936 4,839 2,266 817 – 28 28 13 5 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 77,382 26,904 74 26 12,858 4,636 74 26 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 104,286 100 17,494 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2012 Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $’000’s % $’000’s % Client 2 Client 3 Client 4 Client 6 Client 7 Other 17,794 21,414 7,022 2,176 3,031 27 32 11 3 5 6,662 7,057 2,213 704 1,609 29 31 10 3 7 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 51,437 15,148 78 22 18,245 4,605 80 20 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 66,585 100 22,850 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Client 4 does not represent 5 per cent. of revenues or receivables as of 30 June 2012. Clients 1 and client 5 do not represent 5 per cent. of revenues or receivables as of 31 December 2012. Above clients are Fortune 100 and/or Fortune 500 companies. Details of segment assets and liabilities can be found in the combined statement of financial position. There are no differences between US GAAP and IFRS. Revenues are attributed to geographic areas based upon the location in which the sale originated. IBEX Global Solutions Plc is domiciled in the United Kingdom. All revenues from external customers arose in the United States of America in each of the reported periods. Non-current assets located outside of the United Kingdom totalled $524,000, $522,000, $818,000 and $747,000 for the years 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and the six months to 31 December 2012 respectively. (5) Goodwill 30 June 2010 $’000’s Cost and net book value 8,644 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2011 $’000’s 8,644 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 8,644 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 8,644 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Goodwill arose on the acquisition of the trade and assets of iSky and Murt Inc by TRG Customer Solutions Inc and the merger of Resse with TRG Customer Solutions Inc. All goodwill is allocated to TRG Customer Solutions Inc for impairment purposes. 55 Goodwill is tested annually for impairment or more frequently if there are indications that the value of goodwill may have been impaired. Goodwill has been tested for impairment by comparing the carrying value with the recoverable amount for the TRG Customer Solutions Inc cash generating unit. Impairment of goodwill Key assumptions applied in impairment workings: The recoverable amount of the cash generating unit is determined on a value in use basis using cash flow projections prepared by management covering a five-year period. The first year of the projections are based on detailed budgets prepared by management as part of the Group’s performance and control procedures Subsequent years are based on extrapolations using the key assumptions listed below. The discount rate applied to cash flow projections beyond five-years is extrapolated using a terminal growth rate which represents the expected long term growth rate of the BPO sector. The following rates were used by the Group in the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and the six months to 31 December 2012: Revenue growth rate % Gross margin % Discount rate % Terminal growth rate % 5% 5% 5% 5% 22.4% 22.4% 22.6% 16.5% 15.2 15.2 15.2 15.2 5.0 5.0 5.0 5.0 30 June 2010 30 June 2011 30 June 2012 31 December 2012 The calculation of value in use for the business operations is most sensitive to changes in the following assumptions: Revenue growth Revenue growth assumptions have been derived from projections prepared by the management. Management is of the view that these assumptions are reasonable considering current market conditions. Cost of service delivery and gross margin Cost of service delivery has been projected on the basis of multiple strategies planned by management to ensure profitable operations. These strategies include cost minimisation mechanisms such as offshore migration of labour, centralisation of support activities and increasing efficiency of service delivery, resulting in improved gross margins over the forecasted period. Operating expenses and capital expenditures Operating expenses and capital expenditures have been projected taking into account growth in business volumes and historical trends. Discount rate Discount rates reflect management estimates of the rate of return required for the business and are calculated after taking into account the prevailing risk free rate, industry risk and business risk. Discount rates are calculated using the weighted average cost of capital. Management do not believe that a reasonably possible change in any of the key assumptions would result in an impairment. 56 (6) Intangible assets Cost At 1 July 2009 Additions and adjustments for grants received Disposals Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2010 Amortisation At 1 July 2009 Amortisation charge for the year Eliminated on disposals and adjustment for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2010 Net book value At 30 June 2009 At 30 June 2010 Patents $’000’s Trademarks $’000’s Software $’000’s Total $’000’s 196 – – – 371 – – – 1,686 415 (46) 3 2,253 415 (46) 3 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 371 2,058 ––––––––––– 2,625 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 115 43 – – 731 754 846 797 – – – – (34) 2 (34) 2 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 158 – 1,453 ––––––––––– 81 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 38 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 955 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 605 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,611 ––––––––––– 1,407 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,014 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Adjustments for grants received relate to government grants received for the reimbursement of expenditure on intangible assets. In accordance with the Group accounting policies, this is deducted from the assets carrying value. 57 Cost At 1 July 2010 Additions and adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2011 Amortisation At 1 July 2010 Amortisation charge for the year Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2011 Net book value At 30 June 2010 At 30 June 2011 Cost At 1 July 2011 Additions and adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2012 Amortisation At 1 July 2011 Amortisation charge for the year Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2012 Net book value At 30 June 2011 At 30 June 2012 Cost At 1 July 2012 At 31 December 2012 Amortisation At 1 July 2012 Amortisation charge for the period At 31 December 2012 Net book value At 1 July 2012 At 31 December 2012 Patents $’000’s Trademarks $’000’s Software $’000’s Total $’000’s 196 – – 371 – – 2,058 313 4 2,625 313 4 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 371 2,375 ––––––––––– 2,942 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 158 38 – – – – 1,453 549 2 1,611 587 2 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – 2,004 ––––––––––– 38 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– 605 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– 2,200 ––––––––––– 1,014 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 742 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – – 371 – – 2,375 217 10 2,942 217 10 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 371 2,602 ––––––––––– 3,169 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – – – – – 2,004 254 9 2,200 254 9 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – 2,267 ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 335 ––––––––––– 2,463 ––––––––––– 742 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 706 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Patents $’000’s Trademarks $’000’s Software $’000’s Total $’000’s 196 ––––––––––– 196 371 ––––––––––– 371 2,602 ––––––––––– 2,602 3,169 ––––––––––– 3,169 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – – – 2,267 94 2,463 94 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 196 – 2,361 ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 58 ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 371 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 335 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 241 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,557 ––––––––––– 706 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 612 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Allocation of amortisation charge in the income statement 30 June 2010 Cost of sales Selling, general and administrative expenses 754 43 30 June 2011 544 43 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 250 4 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 797 587 254 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 93 1 ––––––––––– 94 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The intangible assets that have an indefinite life are trademarks and are considered to have an indefinite life on the grounds of the proven longevity of the trademarks and the Group’s commitment to maintaining those trademarks. (7) Property, plant and equipment Leasehold improvements $’000’s Furniture and fittings $’000’s Computers, Communications and Office Equipment $’000’s 2,626 1,436 12,820 125 17,007 730 (434) 4 342 (381) 9 350 (551) (6) 1 – 5 1,423 (1,366) 12 Cost At 1 July 2009 Additions and adjustments for grants received Disposals Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2010 Depreciation At 1 July 2009 Charge for the year Eliminated on disposals and adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2010 Total $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,926 1,406 12,616 131 ––––––––––– 17,076 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,013 960 463 245 5,538 2,190 61 25 7,075 3,420 237 5 140 5 363 1 – 3 740 14 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,215 853 8,092 89 ––––––––––– Net book value At 30 June 2009 Vehicles $’000’s 1,613 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 711 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 973 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 553 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 7,282 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,521 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 64 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 11,249 ––––––––––– 9,932 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,827 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Adjustments for grants received relate to government grants received for the reimbursement of expenditure on property, plant and equipment. In accordance with the Group accounting policies, this is deducted from the assets carrying value. 59 Leasehold improvements $’000’s Furniture and fittings $’000’s Computers, Communications and Office Equipment $’000’s 2,926 1,406 12,613 131 17,076 (87) 22 (284) 25 (909) 50 40 9 (1,240) 106 Cost At 1 July 2010 Additions and adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2011 Depreciation At 1 July 2010 Charge for the year Adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences At 30 June 2011 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,861 1,147 11,754 180 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,215 541 (243) 17 853 217 (357) 11 8,092 2,120 (1,833) 38 89 30 – 7 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,530 724 8,417 126 711 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– At 30 June 2011 331 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 553 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 423 ––––––––––– 4,521 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,337 ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 54 15,942 ––––––––––– 11,249 2,908 (2,433) 73 ––––––––––– 11,797 ––––––––––– 5,827 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,145 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Leasehold improvements $’000’s Furniture and fittings $’000’s Computers, Communications and Office Equipment $’000’s Vehicles $’000’s Total $’000’s 2,861 1,147 11,754 180 15,942 300 (5) 86 1 2,249 (42) 1 – 2,636 (46) Depreciation At 1 July 2011 Charge for the year Adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,156 1,234 13,961 181 ––––––––––– 18,532 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,530 172 23 4 724 210 16 2 8,417 2,409 (39) (30) 126 19 – 1 11,797 2,810 – (23) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,729 952 10,757 146 ––––––––––– At 30 June 2012 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Cost At 1 July 2011 Additions and adjustments for grants received Foreign exchange differences Net book value At 30 June 2011 Total $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Net book value At 30 June 2010 Vehicles $’000’s 331 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 427 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 423 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 282 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 60 ––––––––––– 3,337 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,204 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 54 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 14,584 ––––––––––– 4,145 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,948 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Cost At 1 July 2012 Additions Foreign exchange differences Depreciation At 1 July 2012 Charge for the period Foreign exchange differences Leasehold improvements $’000’s Furniture and fittings $’000’s Computers, Communications and Office Equipment $’000’s 3,156 102 7 1,234 28 15 13,961 490 55 At 31 December 2012 Total $’000’s 181 55 3 18,532 673 80 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,265 1,277 14,506 239 ––––––––––– 19,285 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,729 106 9 952 96 8 10,757 972 46 146 7 3 14,584 1,181 66 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,844 1,056 11,775 156 ––––––––––– Net book value At 30 June 2012 Vehicles $’000’s 427 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 421 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 282 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 221 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,204 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,731 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 83 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 15,831 ––––––––––– 3,948 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,456 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– During the year ended 30 June 2010 the Group received a tenant allowance of $558,000 to build out one floor of its leased office space in Pittsburgh PA. The allowance was adjusted against the total capital expenditure of $689,000. The remaining $131,000 was adjusted against the grant received by the Group during the year of $375,000 from the Commonwealth of` Pennsylvania to be used for working capital purposes, including salaries and the purchase of office equipment, as part of the Group’s expansion of operations. Refer to Note 17 Grants. The company also recorded a $127,000 reduction in the cost basis of additions for the year ended 30 June 2010 in property and equipment of one of its facilities in North Bay, Canada in relation to a grant received from Northern Ontario Heritage Fund Corporation (NOHFC). Refer to Note 17 Grants. 61 Details of property, plant and equipment held under finance lease are as follows: At 30 June 2010 Cost Accumulated depreciation Closing net book value At 30 June 2011 Cost Accumulated depreciation Closing net book value At 30 June 2012 Cost Accumulated depreciation Closing net book value Computers Communication and office equipment $’000’s Vehicles $’000’s Total $’000’s 671 (442) 130 (89) 801 (531) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 229 41 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 152 (6) 139 (120) 291 (126) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 146 19 ––––––––––– 165 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,923 (464) 56 (47) 1,979 (511) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,459 9 1,937 (702) Closing net book value 270 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– At 31 December 2012 Cost Accumulated depreciation ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 56 – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,235 56 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,468 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,993 (702) ––––––––––– 1,291 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (8) Other non-current assets Other non-current assets consist of the following: Long term deposits Long term note receivable Long term deferred expenses Other 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 732 707 600 317 1,044 – 357 554 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,359 – 195 697 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,356 1,955 2,251 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 62 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,468 – – 772 ––––––––––– 2,240 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (9) Trade and other receivables Trade and other receivables consist of the following: Trade receivables – gross Less: provision for doubtful debts Trade receivables – net Prepayments and other Deposits Notes receivable 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 14,712 (92) 16,334 (143) 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 17,641 (147) 22,958 (108) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 14,620 694 317 236 16,191 727 554 1,050 17,494 653 697 – 22,850 1,432 126 – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 15,867 18,522 18,844 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 79 25 (12) 92 83 (32) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 24,408 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Provision for doubtful debts Opening balance as of 1 July Charge for the period Reversals/write-offs against provision Closing balance 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 143 17 (13) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 92 143 147 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 147 – (39) ––––––––––– 108 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (10) Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents consist of the following: Balances with banks in: – current accounts – deposit accounts Cash in hand 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 410 158 546 278 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,808 100 2,186 255 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 568 2 824 4 1,908 17 2,441 13 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 570 828 1,925 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (11) Share capital Opening and closing share capital 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– All shares are equally eligible to receive dividends and the repayment of capital, and represent one vote each at the Annual General Meeting. 63 (12) Additional paid in equity Opening additional paid in equity Additional contributions from equity holders Closing additional paid in equity 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 31,020 6,488 37,508 49 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 37,557 2,064 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 37,508 37,557 39,621 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 39,621 650 ––––––––––– 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (13) Share option plan The amount recognised as compensation cost in profit or loss within the combined statement of comprehensive income for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and the six months ended 31 December 2012 was $523,000, $246,000, $157,000 and $42,000 respectively. The options have a maximum contractual term of no longer than ten years from their date of grant and become exercisable with respect to one-third of the shares on the first anniversary of the grant date and with respect to one thirty-sixth of the shares initially granted on a monthly basis thereafter over two years, unless otherwise noted in the agreement. For all the options granted in the years ended 30 June 2010 and 2011 the exercise price was $1.21. No options were granted in the years ended 30 June 2012 or the period ended 31 December 2012. The exercise prices were set by the Board of Directors at the entry price of the external investors, which were negotiated in arm’s length transactions. No options have been exercised as of 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012. The Group estimates the fair value of its stock options on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes optionpricing method, which requires the use of certain estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amount of share-based compensation cost recognised in the historical financial information. These include estimates of the expected term of stock options, expected volatility of The Resource Group International Limited’s shares, expected dividends, and the risk-free interest rate. (a) Expected term The expected term of options granted during the year ended 30 June 2010 and 2011 is six years. In estimating the expected term, the Group applied the “simplified method,” which assumes all options will be exercised midway between the vesting date and the contractual term of the option. (b) Volatility As The Resource Group International Limited is a private company, estimated volatility was derived by calculating the average historical volatility of certain comparable public companies in the call centre/business process outsourcing sector over the expected term of the options. Management used a volatility of 51.53 per cent. for grant calculations for the years ended 30 June 2010 and 2011. (c) Expected dividends The expected dividend yield is 0 per cent. The Resource Group International Limited does not have a history of paying dividends, nor does it anticipate paying dividends in the foreseeable future. 64 (d) Risk-free rate The risk free rate is the continuously compounded United States nominal treasury rate corresponding to the expected term. The risk free rate used for options granted during the years ended 30 June 2010 and 2011 ranged from 2.83 per cent. to 3.01 per cent. Number of shares No. Options: Outstanding at 30 June 2009 Granted Forfeited or expired 1,420,000 1,010,000 (100,694) Outstanding at 30 June 2010 2,329,306 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Granted Forfeited or expired 685,000 (125,000) ––––––––––– Outstanding at 30 June 2011 2,889,306 Granted Forfeited or expired – (1,169,306) Outstanding at 30 June 2012 1,720,000 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Granted Forfeited or expired – (565,000) ––––––––––– Outstanding at 31 December 2012 1,155,000 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– A summary of the status of the options held by employees of the Group under the Plan as of 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012 is presented below: 30 June 2010 ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Options outstanding Exercise price or range $ 1.12 1.21 Options exercisable –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ 1,277,305 1,052,001 7.18 9.02 1.12 1.21 1,218,083 418,945 7.17 8.78 1.12 1.21 ––––––––––– 2,329,306 ––––––––––– 1,637,028 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2011 ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Options outstanding Exercise price or range $ 1.21 1.21 Options exercisable –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ 1,277,305 1,612,001 6.18 8.67 1.12 1.21 1,277,305 717,140 6.18 7.95 1.12 1.21 ––––––––––– 2,889,306 ––––––––––– 1,994,445 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 65 30 June 2012 ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Options outstanding –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ 620,000 1,100,000 5.08 8.03 1.12 1.21 620,000 745,278 5.08 7.77 1.12 1.21 Exercise price or range $ 1.12 1.21 Options exercisable –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,720,000 1,365,278 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2012 ––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Options outstanding –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ Shares No. Weighted average remaining life (years) Weighted average exercise price $ 595,000 560,000 4.50 8.01 1.12 1.21 595,000 371,667 4.50 7.99 1.12 1.21 Exercise price or range $ 1.12 1.21 Options exercisable –––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,155,000 966,667 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The weighted-average grant date fair value of stock options granted during the years ended 30 June 2010 and 2011 were $0.65 and $0.60 respectively. As of 4 June 2013, the Company has its own stock option plan with options granted to management over Ordinary Shares currently owned by TRGI. Any options of TRGI granted to management of the Company have been refined. (14) Liabilities against assets subject to finance lease Liabilities against assets subject to finance lease are secured by the related assets held under finance leases. Future minimum lease payments at 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012 are as follows: Within one year After one year but not more than five years Total minimum lease payments Less: amounts representing finance charges Present value of minimum lease payments Less: current potion shown under current liabilities 30 June 2010 Minimum Present lease value of payments payments $’000’s $’000’s 138 129 30 June 2011 Minimum Present lease value of payments payments $’000’s $’000’s 126 94 30 June 2012 Minimum Present lease value of payments payments $’000’s $’000’s 774 689 31 December 2012 Minimum Present lease value of payments payments $’000’s $’000’s 543 469 22 –––––––– 17 –––––––– 198 –––––––– 174 –––––––– 723 –––––––– 666 –––––––– 652 –––––––– 583 –––––––– 160 146 324 268 1,497 1,355 1,195 1,052 (14) –––––––– – –––––––– (56) –––––––– – –––––––– (142) –––––––– – –––––––– (143) –––––––– – –––––––– 146 146 268 268 1,355 1,355 1,052 1,052 (130) –––––––– 16 –––––––– –––––––– (130) –––––––– 16 –––––––– –––––––– (94) –––––––– 174 –––––––– –––––––– (94) –––––––– 174 –––––––– –––––––– (679) –––––––– 676 –––––––– –––––––– (679) –––––––– 676 –––––––– –––––––– (372) –––––––– 680 –––––––– –––––––– (372) –––––––– 680 –––––––– –––––––– These lease arrangements have interest rates ranging from 8 per cent. to 15 per cent. for the periods ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and 31 December 2012. At the end of the lease term, the ownership of the assets shall be transferred to the respective entities of the Group. 66 (15) Advances under financing agreement Up until 5 January 2010, the entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited operated under a Purchasing Agreement whereby they agreed to sell their account receivables with recourse to FCC, LLC d/b/a First Growth Capital (“First Capital”). The one year agreement with First Capital allowed for advances of up to a total of $20 million to the entities in the arrangement and required the parties to offer a minimum of $6 million in billed accounts per month to First Capital. Failure to meet this minimum would have resulted in additional fees. The initial funding received by the Group under this arrangement was used to repay the Group’s prior line of credit. Under the terms of the agreement, First Capital agreed to advance up to 85 per cent. of the face value of all accounts receivables generated by the Group. In addition, the parties to the arrangement were able to borrow up to $3 million against services that had been performed but not yet billed to customers. The agreement required the Group to maintain a minimum tangible net worth of $4 million. First Capital was granted a general security interest in the Group as part of this agreement. The Group was charged an interest rate of one month LIBOR plus 6 per cent. (subject to a floor of 7 per cent.) on all advances. In addition the Group discounted each receivable amount sold to First Capital by 0.70 per cent. The discount was increased if a receivable was outstanding for more than 30 days. Also, the Group was charged 0.40 per cent. on each receivable requiring credit insurance. On 5 January 2010, the entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited converted the Purchasing Agreement to a Loan and Security Agreement (“working capital line of credit”). The entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited received initial funding from the new Loan and Security Agreement that was used to repay the borrowings from the Purchasing Agreement. Working capital line of credit On 5 January 2010, the entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited entered into a line of credit agreement (Agreement) with First Capital. The Agreement had a $16 million cap with $13 million allocated to the Group, and a maturity date of 31 March 2011, with an automatic one year renewal in the event either party did not notify its desire to discontinue 60 days prior to the maturity date. Under the Agreement, the Group had the ability to draw up to a certain percentage of its eligible receivables and a certain percentage, as defined in the Agreement, of its eligible unbilled receivables subject to certain limitations, as defined in the Agreement. On 28 October 2010, the Group entered into an Amendment with First Capital which increased the unbilled receivables cap, revised certain financial covenants, and waived past financial covenant violations. On 20 July 2011, the entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited terminated the agreement with First Capital and entered into a revolving line of credit (New Agreement) with Capital Source Bank (“CSB”). The initial funding under the New Agreement was used to repay the borrowings under the previous line of credit from First Capital. The New Agreement has a $15 million cap and a maturity date of 20 July 2014 and the Group has the ability to draw up to a certain percentage, as defined in the Agreement, of its eligible billed and unbilled receivables. The Group is subject to certain financial performance covenants, including a minimum Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio and a minimum Cash Velocity Percentage, both defined in the New Agreement, to ensure continued access to the line of credit. CSB has been granted a general security interest in the Group’s assets (with certain limited exceptions) to secure the New Agreement. The Group is charged an interest rate of one month LIBOR + 5 per cent. (subject to a one month LIBOR rate floor of 1.5 per cent.) per annum. In addition, the Group is charged a monthly collateral management fee of 0.042 per cent. based on the previous month average daily net loan balance and monthly unused line fee of 0.042 per cent. based on subtracting the previous month average daily net loan balance from the Facility Cap, as defined in the New Agreement. On 7 September 2012, CSB granted a waiver to the entities within this combined historical financial information and other subsidiaries of The Resource Group International Limited for past financial covenant defaults, pursuant to an amendment of the New Agreement and agreed to increase the cap to $20 million. The amendment also included extending the maturity date to 20 July 2015 and required an equity investment of $650,000 to the Group by The Resource Group International Limited within 30 days of closing the amendment. The $650,000 investment was made on 1 October 2012. The Group is now charged an interest rate of one month LIBOR + 6 per cent. (subject to one month LIBOR rate floor of 1.5 per cent.) per annum, 67 until the later of 31 March 2013, or the date when specific covenants are met, at which time the interest rate payable will drop to one month LIBOR + 5 per cent. (subject to one month LIBOR rate floor of 1.5 per cent.) per annum. The Group’s minimum Fixed Coverage Charge Ratio covenant is (0.25) to 1.0 for the month ending August 2012 and increases to 1.20 to 1.0 starting with the month ended November 2012 and continuing for the remaining term of the New Agreement. The Group had complied with CSB for four consecutive calendar months for the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio. Pursuant to another amendment to the New agreement dated 5 October 2012 the facility cap was permanently increased to $20 million with an over advance Facility of $800,000 above the facility cap. The over advance Facility had a maturity date of 31 December 2012. (16) Trade and other payables Trade creditors Accrued expenses and payables Accrued salaries and wages 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 3,870 1,869 4,090 4,715 1,739 4,825 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 4,821 1,917 7,749 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 9,829 11,279 14,487 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,777 2,177 10,583 ––––––––––– 17,537 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (17) Grants The Group received grants from various states during the years ended 30 June 30 2009, 2011 and 2012 and the six months ended 31 December 2012 as follows: ● The Group received a Loan and a Conditional Contribution (grant) of $254,000 from Northern Ontario Heritage Fund Corporation (“NOHFC”) related to North Bay facility on 30 November 2009. The funds were bifurcated into a non-revolving term loan in aggregate principal amount of up to $127,000, carrying an interest rate of 2.75 per cent. per annum, and grant of up to $127,000. Pursuant to the sale by the Group of its Canadian assets, IBEX Global (Canada) Inc. and the NOHFC entered in to a consent agreement whereby the NOHFC provided its consent to the sale of assets, and terminated all covenants of IBEX Global (Canada) Inc. under the Loan and Conditional Contribution Agreement. As a result, the Group paid back the loan on 28 June 2010. The Group recognised the grant as a reduction in the carrying value of its fixed assets. Refer to Note 7 Property and Equipment. ● The Group received grants totaling $548,000 from the State of West Virginia on 1 July 2010. These funds were disbursed through the period ending 30 June 2011 to support a customised industrial training program. The Group has received a letter from the State, dated 16 August 2011, confirming that the Group has fulfilled and met the conditions of the grant. ● The Group received a performance-based grant from the State of Virginia to reimburse recruiting and training expenses for the call center in Hampton, Virginia. Based upon the forecasted creation of additional jobs, the State will reimburse the Group for each net new job created after 1 January 2011. Through 30 June 2011, the Group received $78,000 in creation of new jobs. ● The Group was granted a total of $375,000 on 30 December 2009, from the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania acting through the Department of Community and Economic Development. The funds were used for working capital as part of the Group’s expansion of operations (the Project) in Allegheny County, Pennsylvania. The grant requires the Group to create new, full-time jobs at the Project site through 30 June 2012; and to meet certain other conditions. Based on present facts and circumstances, the Group believes that it is on schedule for the creation of new full-time jobs by 30 June 2012. The Group has already met the remaining conditions. ● The Group received grants in a total of $475,000 from the State of West Virginia during fiscal year ended 30 June 2012 for its facilities in Beckley $159,000, Elkins $161,000 and Charleston $155,000. These funds were treated as a reduction in cost of sales for the period ending 30 June 2013 to support a customised industrial training program. 68 ● The Group recorded grant of $146,000 from State of Tennessee, Department of Economic and Community Development for the provision of employee instruction/training and associated expenses in support of the group’s commitment to maintain and increase jobs and income in Tennessee. The Grant Contract is effective for the period commencing on 21 May 2012 and ending on 20 May 2015. The total amount to be awarded to the group under this Grant Contract is $315,000. These funds were treated as a reduction in cost of sales for the six months ended December 2012. (18) Contingencies and commitments Contingencies The entities within this historical financial information are subject to lawsuits and claims filed in the normal course of business. Management does not believe that the outcome of any of the proceedings will have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business results of operations, liquidity or financial condition. Although management does not believe that any such proceedings will have material effect, no assurances to that effect can be given. The significant claims or legal proceedings against the entities within this historical financial information are as follows: In March 2006, Reese Brothers, Inc. (RBI) filed a claim against the United States Postal Service (USPS) challenging the constitutionality of “relationship test cooperative mailing regulations” promulgated by the USPS and seeking damages in the nature of over-payments for postal charges, lost business, and other injuries. In June 2006, the USPS filed a counter claim and third-party complaint joining Reese Teleservices, Inc. (RTI), which was acquired by TRGGS during the year ended 30 June 2007, as a third-party defendant under a theory of “successor-in-interest” status to RBI. This matter was settled in February 2013 by all parties by an exchange of mutual releases, without any payments of money or other obligations. In May 2012, the landlord (LL) of a former TRGCS Oil City centre (Facility) filed a case in the Court of Common Pleas of Venango County, Pennsylvania. LL alleges that TRGCS remained in Facility through March 2012 and owed rent through that date. TRGCS has settled case for a $10,000 payment to be made on 31 March 2013, when an order releasing TRGCS in full and dismissing the case with prejudice will be entered. Commitments The Group has an annual telecommunication service commitment with one of its carriers. The carrier agreement was signed in January 2012 for a three year term with minimum annual commitment for $600,000. The agreement has a provision for an early termination at the one year anniversary with a sixty day written notice. The Group is also subject to early termination provisions in certain telecommunications contracts, which if enforced by the telecommunications providers, would subject the Group to early terminations fees. To date, these early termination provisions had not been triggered by the Group. (19) Operating leases Certain subsidiary IBEX companies have acquired computer equipment, software, office facilities, furniture and fixtures and office premises under operating lease arrangements, of which certain arrangements contain renewal options and escalation clauses for operating expenses and inflation. Rent expense is recognized on a straight line basis over the life of the lease term. Future minimum lease rentals under operating leases for years ending subsequent to 31 December 2012 are as follows: Operating leases $’000’s Within one year After one year but not more than five years More than five years 5,866 12,827 3,615 ––––––––––– 22,308 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 69 Rental expenditure was approximately $3.8 million, $4 million, $5.6 million and $3.2 million for the years ended June 30, 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012 respectively. (20) Retirement benefits obligations TRG Philippines Inc. operate an unfunded defined benefit plan for qualifying employees. Under the plan, the employees are entitled to one half month’s salary for every year of service, with 6 months or more of service considered as one year. One half month’s salary has been defined to include the following: – 15 days salary based on the latest salary rate – cash equivalent to 5 days service incentive leave – one-twelfth of the 13th month’s pay An employee is entitled to retirement benefits only upon attainment of a retirement age of 60 years and completion of at least five years of previous credited service. No other post-retirement benefits are provided to these employees. The most recent actuarial valuations of the present value of the defined benefit obligation was carried out at 30 June 2012. The present value of the defined benefit obligation, and the related current service cost and past service cost, were measured using the projected unit credit method. The principal assumptions used for the purposes of the actuarial valuations are as follows: 30 June 2010 % 30 June 2011 % 10.58 8.00 9.41 8.00 Discount rate Expected rate of salary increase 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 % % 6.46 8.00 6.46 8.00 Amounts recognised within cost of sales in the combined statement of comprehensive income in respect of defined benefit plan are as follows: Current service cost Interest on obligation Actuarial (gains)/losses recognised during the year 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 9 2 58 10 63 ––––––––––– 74 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 68 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 85 17 – ––––––––––– 102 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 57 15 (15) ––––––––––– 57 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The amount included in the combined statement of financial position arising from a direct subsidiary, IBEX Global Philippines, in respect of its defined benefit plan obligation as of 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and 31 December 2012 is as follows: Present value of unfunded defined benefit obligation Unrecognised actuarial gains/(losses) 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 87 16 181 (10) 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 155 133 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 103 171 288 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 70 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 353 – ––––––––––– 353 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The movement in the present value of the defined benefit obligation in the current period is as follows: Opening present value of define benefit obligation Foreign exchange differences Current service cost Interest cost Actuarial (gains)/losses Present value of defined benefit obligation 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 12 – 9 2 64 87 9 58 10 17 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 181 5 85 17 (133) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 87 181 155 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 63,916 4,217 (25) 18,008 75,701 3,495 24 18,411 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 155 141 57 – – ––––––––––– 353 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (21) Expenses by nature Employee benefit expenses Depreciation and amortisation Foreign exchange gains and losses Other expenses Analysed as: Cost of sales Selling, general and administrative expenses 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 82,682 3,064 164 20,717 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 86,116 97,631 106,627 53,226 1,275 166 11,159 ––––––––––– 65,826 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 69,962 16,154 79,627 18,004 90,732 15,895 57,431 8,395 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 86,116 97,631 106,627 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 65,826 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (22) Other income Gain on write back of inter-company payables 150 ––––––––––– 150 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 71 – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 2 ––––––––––– 2 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (23) Profit before income taxes Profit before taxation is stated after charging: 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s Operating lease expenses Land and buildings 3,791 4,025 5,624 3,197 Depreciation and amortisation Depreciation of property, plant and equipment: Owned Held under finance leases Amortisation Foreign exchange gains/losses 3,261 159 797 (25) 2,869 39 587 24 2,264 546 254 164 906 275 94 166 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (24) Employee information Expenses recognised for employee benefits are analysed below: Salaries and other employee costs Social security and other taxes Employee share options expense Retirement – contribution plan Pensions – defined benefits plan 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 49,128 14,196 523 60 9 59,966 15,363 246 68 58 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 65,858 16,506 157 76 85 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 63,916 75,701 82,682 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 42,779 10,310 42 38 57 ––––––––––– 53,226 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Average number of employees are analysed below: Direct labour Administrative staff 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 3,267 716 4,435 863 4,523 784 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,983 5,298 5,307 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (25) Remuneration of key management personnel 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s Managerial remuneration Short term employee benefits Retirement benefits Employee share option 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 2,173 266 126 523 3,392 38 160 246 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,862 29 48 157 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,088 3,836 2,096 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 6,655 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,534 1,121 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,225 299 108 42 ––––––––––– 2,674 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The key management personnel include the senior management team having an annual base salary of USD100,000 or more. 72 The number of key management personnel was 26, 27, 34, and 28 for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and the six months ended 31 December 2012 respectively. The number of key management personnel participating in defined contribution retirement benefit schemes was 20, 20, 27, and 18 for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011, 2012 and the six months ended 31 December 2012 respectively. Remuneration for highest paid key management 30 June 2010 $’000’s Managerial remuneration Short term employee benefits Retirement benefits Employee share option 252 32 8 – 30 June 2011 $’000’s 289 – 23 3 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 335 – – 73 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 292 315 408 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 716 1,125 65 2 1,936 20 14 7 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 202 2 – – ––––––––––– 204 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (26) Finance costs Interest on borrowings Factoring fees Finance charges on leased assets Bank charges 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,531 6 162 1 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,908 1,977 1,700 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 789 199 17 49 (29) 41 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 860 5 64 2 ––––––––––– 931 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (27) Income taxes The tax provision consists of the following: Current US Federal tax US State tax Other than US ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,005 61 105 (456) (7) (76) ––––––––––– (539) ––––––––––– 466 Income tax on continuing operations Income tax on discontinued operations – 21 84 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Deferred tax/(benefits) US Federal tax US State tax Other than US 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (286) (42) (12) ––––––––––– (340) ––––––––––– (279) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 64 2 (11) ––––––––––– 55 ––––––––––– 160 – – 16 ––––––––––– 16 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 36 9 2 ––––––––––– 47 ––––––––––– 63 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 450 16 (279) – 160 – 63 – ––––––––––– 466 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 73 ––––––––––– (279) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 160 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 63 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Income from discontinued operations has been recognised in the combined statement of comprehensive income net of the $16,000 charge above. The US. tax provision calculations include TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions. Additionally, included in the provision are TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions and TRG Customer Solutions Canada Inc., TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and Virtual World (Private) Limited. Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes, as well as net operating losses and tax credit carry forward. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates that will apply to taxable income in the periods the deferred tax item is expected to be settled or realized. The tax effects of the Group’s temporary differences and carry forwards are as follows: Tax effect of deductible/(taxable temporary differences) 30 June 2010 $’000’s Tax effect of deductible temporary differences: – Provisions and write-offs against trade debts 6 – Unpaid accrued expenses/compensation 74 – Net operating losses 2,681 – Intangibles 112 Total deferred tax Comprising: Deferred tax asset Deferred tax liability 30 52 5,347 96 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,873 3,844 5,525 (582) (606) (53) ––––––––––– (1,241) Less: Deferred tax asset not recognised 29 129 3,567 119 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Tax effect of taxable differences: – Fixed assets – Intangibles – Prepayments and others 30 June 2011 $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (422) (711) (57) ––––––––––– (1,190) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,632 (2,676) 2,654 (3,358) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (1,044) (704) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 18 (1,062) – (704) ––––––––––– (1,044) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (704) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (426) (777) – ––––––––––– (1,203) ––––––––––– 4,322 (5,081) ––––––––––– (759) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – (759) ––––––––––– (759) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 33 82 5,471 88 ––––––––––– 5,674 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (549) (823) – ––––––––––– (1,372) ––––––––––– 4,302 (5,108) ––––––––––– (806) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – (806) ––––––––––– (806) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Deferred tax asset on deductible temporary differences (including unused tax losses) has not been recognised in these financial information, as the management is of the view that it is not probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available in the foreseeable future against which deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses can be utilised. At 31 December 2012, the Group’s US federal and state net operating loss carry forwards for income tax purposes are $4.4 million (30 June 2012: $3.8 million) which will begin to expire in 2032. The Group’s Canadian subsidiary has net operating loss carry forwards of $12 million for Canadian income tax purposes, expiring over the period 2015 through 2032. The Group’s UK subsidiary has net operating loss carry forward of $2.6 million. These amounts are based on the income tax returns filed for the year ended 30 June 2012 and estimated amounts for the half year ended 31 December 2012. The timing and manner, in which the group will utilise the US net operating loss carry forwards in any year, or in total, may be limited by provisions of the Internal Revenue Code regarding changes in ownership. Management has evaluated the Group’s tax positions and concluded that the Group had taken no uncertain tax positions that require adjustment to the combined financial statements. The Group recognises interest 74 and penalties related to uncertain tax position in income tax expense. As of 31 December 2012; the Group had no provision for interest or penalties related to uncertain tax position. The years 2009-2012 are open to examination by the tax authorities. Reconciliation of effective tax rate Profit/(loss) for the year Income tax expense/(benefit) 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 1,344 450 (2,204) (279) ––––––––––– 1,794 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Income tax expense/ (benefit) using applicable tax rate State taxes (net of federal tax effect) Effect of tax and exchange rates in foreign jurisdictions Non-deductible expenses Change in unrecognised temporary differences ––––––––––– (2,483) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s (4,199) 160 (235) 63 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (4,039) (172) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 2010 % US$’000 30 June 2011 % US$’000 30 June 2012 % US$’000 31 December 2012 % US$’000 34 610 34 (844) 34 (1,373) 34 (58) 4 112 4 (122) 4 (145) 4 (6) – (11) 7 (163) 4 (152) (28) 49 10 224 (7) 168 (3) 107 (30) 51 (28) ––––––––– 20 ––––––––– ––––––––– (485) ––––––––– 450 ––––––––– ––––––––– (27) ––––––––– 11 ––––––––– ––––––––– 682 ––––––––– (279) ––––––––– ––––––––– (43) ––––––––– (4) ––––––––– ––––––––– 1,723 ––––––––– 160 ––––––––– ––––––––– (16) ––––––––– (36) ––––––––– ––––––––– 27 ––––––––– 63 ––––––––– ––––––––– (28) Related parties – due to and from affiliates During the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and six months ended 31 December 2012, the Group entered into transactions with certain affiliates owned wholly or partially by The Resource Group International Limited, the ultimate parent of the IBEX Group. The transactions took place at fair value. TRG Holdings LLC is 100 per cent. owned by The Resource Group International Limited and acts as a holding company of The Resource Group International Limited businesses in US. Effective from 1 January 2009 to 31 December 2011 intercompany subcontracted services provided among different affiliates were billed through TRG Holdings LLC. TRG BPO Solutions, Inc. is 100 per cent. owned by TRG Holdings LLC. Effective from 1 January 2012 intercompany subcontracted services provided among differences affiliates were billed through TRG Holdings LLC. 75 The related party transactions for the Group as of and for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 and 31 December 2012 are as follows: Service delivery revenue $’000’s TRG Holdings, LLC The Resource Group International Limited Blasiar, Inc. (dba Alert) Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Senegal TRG iSKY, Inc. TRG Private Ltd. Stratasoft, Inc Balance as of 30 June 2010 Balance as of 30 June 2011 Total due to affiliates long term $’000’s 1,899 4,538 1,039 – (169) – 828 340 – – – – 837 – – – – – – – – – – – – – 101 360 9,408 32 178 20 157 – – (263) – – – – – – – (41) (30) – – – – – – – – (489) – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,904 4,538 11,295 (334) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Service delivery revenue $’000’s TRG Holdings, LLC The Resource Group International Limited Blasiar, Inc. (dba Alert) Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG Senegal TRG iSky, Inc. Stratasoft, Inc Year ended 30 June 2010 Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $’000’s $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (658) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Year ended 30 June 2011 Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $’000’s $’000’s $’000’s Total due to affiliates long term $’000’s 2,078 4,505 1,385 – (947) – – 1,299 – – 820 – – 462 – – – – – – – – – – – – 101 833 9,333 50 144 – 20 480 – (262) – – – – – (7) – – (25) – – – – – – (1,194) – – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,659 4,505 12,346 (294) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 76 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,141) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Service delivery revenue $’000’s TRG Holdings, LLC TRG BPO Solutions, Ir. The Resource Group International Limited Blasiar, Inc. (dba Alert) Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG Senegal TRG iSky, Inc. Stratasoft, Inc Balance as of 30 June 2012 Balance as of 31 December 2012 Total due to affiliates long term $’000’s 966 1,393 2,336 2,471 41 1,965 – – (1,082) – – – 502 – – 898 – – 485 – – – – – – – – – 38 – – 101 857 10,604 33 60 – 20 506 – (60) – – – – – (9) – – (21) – – – – – – (1,126) – – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,244 4,845 14,187 (90) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Service delivery revenue $’000’s TRG Holdings, LLC TRG BPO Solutions, Ir. The Resource Group International Limited Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG Senegal TRG iSky, Inc. Stratasoft, Inc Year ended 30 June 2012 Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $’000’s $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,208) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Year ended 31 December 2012 Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $’000’s $’000’s $’000’s Total due to affiliates long term $’000’s – 1,304 – 2,825 39 1,999 – – (1,082) – – 251 – – 284 – – 283 – – – – – – – – – – – 955 10,604 162 67 – 20 492 – (63) – – – – (7) – – (21) – – – – – (1,395) – – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,122 2,825 14,338 (91) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 77 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,477) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (29) Cash (used in)/generated from operations Profit/(loss) before income taxes Adjustments for: Depreciation and amortisation Finance costs Write back intercompany payable Provision for retirement benefit expense (Gain)/loss on sale of fixed assets Income from discontinued operations Employee share option expense Changes in operating assets and liabilities: Trade and other receivables Trade and other payables Deferred revenue/expense Due to/from affiliates Net cash (used in)/generated from operating activities 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 2,237 (2,483) (4,039) (172) 4,217 1,908 150 5 (3,491) 29 523 3,495 1,977 – 68 7 3,064 1,700 – 102 – 1,275 931 – 57 – 246 157 42 (1,153) (3,214) 227 (6,380) (2,449) 943 (50) 392 (637) 3,022 113 (1,978) (5,747) 3,123 (279) 119 ––––––––––– (4,942) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,146 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s ––––––––––– 1,504 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (647) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (30) Financial instruments (a) Financial risk management The Group’s activities expose it to a variety of financial risks: market risk (including interest rate risk and currency risk), credit risk and liquidity risk. Financial instruments by category are as follows: 30 June 2010 $’000’s Financial assets category: loans and receivables Non-current assets Long term deposits 732 Long term notes receivable 707 Current assets Trade receivable Deposits Notes receivable Due from affiliates Cash and bank balances 1,044 – 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 1,359 – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,439 1,044 1,359 1,468 – ––––––––––– 1,468 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 14,620 317 236 11,295 570 16,191 554 1,050 12,346 828 17,494 697 – 14,187 1,925 22,850 126 – 14,338 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 27,038 30,969 34,303 ––––––––––– 28,477 Financial liabilities at amortised cost Line of credit Liabilities against assets subject to finance lease Due to affiliates Trade and other payables 30 June 2011 $’000’s ––––––––––– 32,013 ––––––––––– 35,662 ––––––––––– 39,768 ––––––––––– 41,236 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 9,745 146 992 9,829 11,158 268 2,436 11,279 11,983 1,355 2,298 14,487 14,597 1,052 2,568 17,537 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 20,712 25,141 30,123 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 78 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35,754 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Risks managed and measured by the Group are explained below: (b) Concentration of credit risk Financial instruments which potentially expose the Group to concentrations of credit risk consist primarily of cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable (see Note 4). The Group’s cash and cash equivalents are held with US and foreign commercial banks. The balance at times may exceed insured limits. Credit rating breakup of balances: AA AAA-1 A+ A ABBB+ Non-rated 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 8 30 – 307 118 77 21 9 21 84 – 2 191 90 436 4 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 29 4 246 1,557 – – 72 17 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 570 828 1,925 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 52 32 – 2,152 205 – – 13 ––––––––––– 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The ageing of trade debtors at year end is as follows: Due 0 to 30 days Due 31 to 60 days Due 61 to 90 days Due 91 to 180 days Due over 180 days Less: provision for doubtful debts 30 June 2010 $’000’s 30 June 2011 $’000’s 13,926 399 228 86 73 (92) 13,586 505 1,883 286 74 (143) 30 June 31 December 2012 2012 $’000’s $’000’s 14,738 2,218 342 267 76 (147) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 14,620 16,191 17,494 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 19,094 3,331 566 568 – (709) ––––––––––– 22,850 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The Group does not hold any collateral against these assets. Financial assets other than trade debts do not contain any impaired or non-performing assets. (c) Foreign currency risk Currency risk arises mainly where receivables and payables exist due to transactions entered into foreign currencies. The Group primarily has foreign currency exposures in Pakistan Rupee, Pound Sterling and Philippine Peso. However the majority of the transactions of the Group are denominated in United States Dollar ($) and accordingly foreign currency exposure is not significant to the Group’s financial position and performance. (d) Interest rate risk Interest risk is the risk that the value of the financial instrument will fluctuate due to changes in the market interest rates. The Group is exposed to interest rate risk in respect of borrowings and bank balances. Effective interest rates and maturities are given in respective notes to the financial statements. 79 (e) Liquidity Based on current operating plans, the Group believes that existing cash and cash equivalents will be sufficient to meet the Group’s anticipated operating needs through the end of June 2013. However, there are a number of assumptions built into the Group’s current operating plans. If these assumptions do not materialise, the Group may need to seek additional financing or management may need to implement a reduced spending plan to fund operations in the 2013 fiscal year. Financial liabilities in accordance with their contractual maturities are presented below: 30 June 2010 Line of credit Finance lease liabilities Trade payables and accrued expenses Due to affiliates Carrying value Total contractual cash flows Less than 1 year Between 1 to 2 years Between 2 to 5 years 9,745 146 9,745 160 9,745 138 – 22 – – 9,829 992 9,829 992 9,829 334 – 658 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 20,712 20,726 20,046 680 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Carrying value Total contractual cash flows 11,158 268 11,279 2,436 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Less than 1 year Between 1 to 2 years Between 2 to 5 years 11,158 324 11,158 126 – 198 – – 11,279 2,435 11,279 294 – 2,141 – – 30 June 2011 Line of credit Finance lease liabilities Trade payables and accrued expenses Due to affiliates ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 25,141 25,196 22,857 2,339 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Carrying value Total contractual cash flows 11,983 1,355 14,487 2,298 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Less than 1 year Between 1 to 2 years Between 2 to 5 years 11,983 1,497 11,983 774 – 723 – – 14,487 2,298 14,487 90 – 2,208 – – 30 June 2012 Line of credit Finance lease liabilities Trade payables and accrued expenses Due to affiliates ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 30,123 30,265 27,334 2,931 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 80 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2012 Line of credit Liabilities against assets subject to finance lease Trade payables and accrued expenses Due to affiliates Carrying value Total contractual cash flows Less than 1 year Between 1 to 2 years Between 2 to 5 years 14,597 14,597 14,597 – – 1,052 1,195 543 652 – 17,537 2,568 17,537 2,568 17,537 91 – 2,477 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35,754 35,897 32,768 3,129 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (f) Fair value of financial instruments Fair value is the amount for which an asset could be exchanged, or liability settled, between knowledgeable willing parties in an arm’s length transaction. Consequently, differences can arise between the carrying value and fair value estimates. The estimated fair value of financial assets and liabilities is considered not significantly different from carrying values as the items are either short-term in nature or periodically re-priced. (31) Capital risk management The Group’s objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern in order to provide returns for shareholders and benefits for other stakeholders and to maintain an optimal capital structure to reduce the cost of capital. The capital structure of the Group at the year end consisted of cash and cash equivalents and equity attributable to equity holders of the parent, comprising issued capital, reserves and retained losses. In order to maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust the amount of dividends paid to shareholders, return capital to shareholders, issue new shares or sell assets to reduce debt. (32) Divestiture of Door to Door Business Unit The ultimate parent entity, The Resource Group International Limited, incorporated a wholly owned subsidiary called TRG Field Solutions (“TRG FS”) to assume the operations of the Door to Door business unit of IBEX US by virtue of a Contribution Agreement during fiscal year ended 30 June 2010. As per the agreement, TRG agreed to transfer 110 shares of Series A Preferred Stock of IBEX US to TRG FS at an amount of $1.035 million. TRG FS issued common stock for an equivalent amount to The Resource Group International Limited as consideration for the preferred stock. At 31 July 2009, IBEX sold the assets and contributed the liabilities of its Door to Door business unit to TRG FS. The net asset of the business unit were sold in exchange for the retirement of the 100 shares of preferred stock owned by TRG FS in IBEX US. The value of the preferred stock retired approximated the net asset value of the assets sold and liabilities transferred on the transfer date. 81 Following is the summary of assets and liabilities related to the Group’s Field Solutions business unit that was transferred to TRG FS as of 31 July 2009 and the summary of assets and liabilities as of 30 June 2009: Accounts receivable Prepaid expenses and other Property and equipment Accounts payable Advances under financing agreement Accrued expenses and other liabilities 31 July 2009 $’000’s 30 June 2009 $’000’s 3,921 156 27 (638) (1,693) (738) 4,119 153 27 (856) (1,313) (560) ––––––––––– 1,035 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,570 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The Group has reviewed the requirements of IFRS 5, “Non-Current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations”, and determined that the spin-off of the Door to Door business unit met the criteria to be presented as a discontinued operation. Analysis of the result and cash flows of discontinued operations is as follows: 30 June 2010 $’000’s Revenue Cost of sales 1,443 (1,398) ––––––––––– Profit before tax of discontinued operations Tax 45 (16) ––––––––––– Profit after tax of discontinued operations 29 ––––––––––– Operating cash flows Investing cash flows Financing cash flows 155 – 380 ––––––––––– Total cash flows 535 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 82 (33) Disposal – Canadian Operations of IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc. On 25 June 2010, IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc. entered into an asset sale agreement with a third party to dispose of substantially all of its Canadian assets and operations for a gross consideration of approximately $6.3 million, which included a non-interest bearing promissory note receivable of approximately $0.9 million payable over twenty-four months. The details of the assets and liabilities disposed of were as follows: $’000’s Proceeds Tangible fixed assets Other assets Goodwill Accrued vacation Sign up bonuses 6,271 507 31 2,666 (9) (14) ––––––––––– Gain on disposal of Canadian operations of IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc Reclassification of cumulative foreign exchange balance Loss on retirement of assets Total gain on sale of assets for the year ended 30 June 2010 3,090 ––––––––––– 443 (42) ––––––––––– 3,491 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The Group has reviewed the requirements of IFRS 5, “Non-Current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations” and did not deem the sale of substantially all of its Canadian assets and operations to constitute a separate component for the purposes of determining whether the disposal should be considered a discontinued operation. This assessment was based upon the fact that all the activities, customers and contracts of IBEX Global Solutions (Canada) Inc were operating as an amalgamated part of the Group business, and the disposal of individual assets and operations did not constitute an operating unit on this basis. (34) Subsequent events Please refer to Part 4 Additional Information for details of the following subsequent events: – changes in the share capital of the Company (paragraph 2 of Part 4) – adoption of an employee share options plan (paragraph 4 of Part 4) – formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 11 of Part 4) – tax indemnification agreement related to the formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 12.8 of Part 4) 83 PART 3C UNAUDITED INTERIM FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2011 (WITH AUDITED COMPARATIVES FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2012) Combined Statements of Comprehensive Income For the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 Revenue Cost of sales Notes 2011 Unaudited $’000’s 2012 Audited $’000’s 3 52,485 (45,676) 66,585 (57,431) ––––––––––– Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses 6,809 (7,940) ––––––––––– Operating (loss)/profit (1,131) Other expenses: Finance costs 11 Loss before income taxes Income tax expense 12 Net loss Other comprehensive loss: Foreign currency translation adjustment (1,132) ––––––––––– (2,263) (87) ––––––––––– (2,350) 4 ––––––––––– Total comprehensive loss attributable to equity holders The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 84 (2,346) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 9,154 (8,395) ––––––––––– 759 (931) ––––––––––– (172) (63) ––––––––––– (235) (61) ––––––––––– (296) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Financial Position As at 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 Notes Assets Non current assets: Goodwill Other intangible assets Property, plant and equipment Other non-current assets Total non current assets Current assets: Trade and other receivables Deferred expenses Due from affiliates Cash and cash equivalents 2011 Unaudited $’000’s 2012 Audited $’000’s 8,644 835 4,244 1,992 8,644 612 3,456 2,240 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 15,715 14,952 20,117 1,426 12,754 2,292 24,408 907 14,338 2,454 4 5 Total current assets ––––––––––– 36,589 ––––––––––– Total assets 52,304 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Equity and liabilities Share capital and reserves Share capital Additional paid in capital Other reserves Retained loss 6 7 8 1,464 37,557 662 (21,744) 18,517 705 404 578 1,082 2,300 707 806 – 680 1,082 2,477 711 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,909 5,027 12,295 726 14,524 1,556 355 14,597 372 17,537 918 91 ––––––––––– 29,456 ––––––––––– 34,365 ––––––––––– Total equity and liabilities 52,304 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 85 1,464 40,271 610 (23,828) ––––––––––– 9 Total liabilities 57,059 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 17,939 Total non current liabilities Current liabilities: Line of credit Obligation under finance lease – current portion Trade and other payables Deferred revenue – current portion Due to affiliates – current portion 42,107 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Total equity Non current liabilities: Deferred tax liabilities Deferred revenue – non-current portion Obligation under finance lease – non-current portion Due to affiliates – non-current portion Retirement benefits obligations Other ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 33,515 ––––––––––– 38,542 ––––––––––– 57,059 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Changes in Equity For the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 Other reserves Issued, subscribed and paid-up capital Amount $000’s As at 30 June 2011 (Audited) Net loss Other comprehensive income Total comprehensive income for the year Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 December 2011 (Unaudited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 30 June 2012 (Audited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 December 2012 (Audited) 1,464 – – Additional paid in capital $’000’s Employee share option plan $’000’s Foreign currency translation reserve $’000’s Retained loss $’000’s Total equity $000’s 37,557 – – 1,480 – – (972) – 4 (19,394) (2,350) – 20,135 (2,350) 4 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 4 – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– – 150 ––––––––––– 150 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 37,557 – – 1,630 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 2,064 – – – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 2,064 7 ––––––––––– 7 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 39,621 – – 1,637 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 650 – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 650 ––––––––––– 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– 1,679 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (968) – (40) ––––––––––– (40) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,008) – (61) ––––––––––– (61) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,069) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 86 ––––––––––– (2,350) – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (21,744) (1,849) – ––––––––––– (1,849) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,593) (235) – ––––––––––– (235) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,828) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,346) 150 ––––––––––– 150 ––––––––––– 17,939 (1,849) (40) ––––––––––– (1,889) 2,064 7 ––––––––––– 2,071 ––––––––––– 18,121 (235) (61) ––––––––––– (296) 650 42 ––––––––––– 692 ––––––––––– 18,517 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Cashflows For and six months ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 Cash flows from operating activities: Cash generated from /(used in) operations Interest paid Taxes paid Notes 2011 Unaudited $’000’s 2012 Audited $’000’s 13 2,314 (1,132) (126) (647) (931) (151) ––––––––––– Net cash used in operating activities 1,056 Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of property and equipment (421) ––––––––––– Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Borrowings on line of credit Repayment of line of credit Grants received Capital contributions from parent undertaking Payments on capital lease obligations Net cash generated from financing activities Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents Net increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash at beginning of period 5 (673) ––––––––––– (673) 12,295 (11,158) – – (331) 2,614 – 57 650 (303) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 806 23 3,018 (87) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 828 529 1,925 2,292 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 87 (1,729) (421) ––––––––––– Cash at end of period ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Notes to the Historical Financial Information For the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 (1) Nature of the business IBEX Group is a global portfolio of companies in the contact center and related business process outsourcing (BPO) business operating from the United States, Philippines, United Kingdom, Pakistan and Senegal. Service offerings include customer care support, business and consumer inbound and outbound telesales and technical support services. IBEX Group also offers enabling technology solutions including Interactive Voice Response (IVR). (2) Basis of preparation The unaudited combined historical financial information for the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 and as at those dates has been prepared for inclusion in the AIM Admission Document dated 24 June 2013 on the basis of preparation and under the accounting policies set out in notes 2 and 3 to the audited combined historical financial information included in Part 3B. This unaudited combined historical financial information does not constitute statutory accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Companies Act 2006, is not a set of general purpose financial statements under paragraph three of IFRS 1 – First Time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards and does not comply with IAS 34 – Interim Financial Reporting. The Directors of the Company are responsible for preparation of this unaudited combined historical financial information. (3) Operating segments This historical financial information has been prepared of the basis on a single reportable segment. Whilst the group operates in different locations, there are no multiple products or lines of services upon which the results reported to chief operating decision maker are segregated and analysed. Revenue Gross margin Operating (loss)/profit US GAAP to IFRS adjustments 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 52,485 6,809 (1,131) – 66,585 9,154 745 14 ––––––––––– Reportable operating (loss)/profit (1,131) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 759 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 92.65 per cent. and 91.67 per cent. of the total revenue was earned from customers in United States of America for the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 2012 respectively. 88 The following table summarises those non related party customers with revenue or accounts receivable in excess of 5 per cent. total revenue or total receivables for the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 2012 respectively. The revenue analysis below does not form part of the Group’s segmental reporting but is provided voluntarily. 31 December 2011 (Unaudited) Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $000’s % $000’s % Client Client Client Client Client 1 2 3 5 6 Other 7,414 12,939 7,166 2,883 9,298 14 25 14 5 18 2,294 4,407 3,645 555 2,868 13 25 21 3 16 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 39,700 12,785 76 24 13,769 4,008 78 22 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 52,485 100 17,777 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2012 (Audited) Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $000’s % $000’s % Client Client Client Client Client Other 2 3 4 6 7 17,794 21,414 7,022 2,176 3,031 27 32 11 3 5 6,662 7,057 2,213 704 1,609 29 31 10 3 7 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 51,437 15,148 78 22 18,245 4,605 80 20 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 66,585 100 22,850 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Client 4 does not represent 5 per cent. of revenues or receivables as of 31 December 2011 and client 1 and client 5 does not represent 5 per cent. of revenues or receivables as of 31 December 2012. Above clients are Fortune 100 and/or Fortune 500 companies. Details of segment assets and liabilities can be found in the combined statement of financial position. There are no differences between US GAAP and IFRS. Revenues are attributed to geographic areas based upon the location in which the sale originated. IBEX Global Solutions Plc is domiciled in the United Kingdom. All revenues from external customers arose in the United States of America in each of the reported periods. Non-current assets located outside of the United Kingdom totalled $472,000 and $747,000 for the six months to 31 December 2001 and 2012 respectively. 89 (4) Trade and other receivables Trade and other receivables consist of the following: Trade receivables – gross Less: provision for doubtful debts Trade receivables – net Prepayments and other Deposits Notes receivable 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 18,090 (313) 22,958 (108) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 17,777 1,602 246 492 22,850 1,432 126 – ––––––––––– 20,117 ––––––––––– 24,408 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 2,152 110 2,186 255 (5) Cash and bank balances Cash and cash equivalents consist of the following: Balances with banks in: – current accounts – deposit accounts Cash in hand ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,262 30 2,441 13 ––––––––––– 2,292 (6) ––––––––––– 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s Share capital Opening and closing share capital 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– All shares are equally eligible to receive dividends and the repayment of capital, and represent one vote at the Annual General Meeting. (7) Additional paid in equity Opening additional paid in equity (June 2011 and June 2012) Additional contributions from equity holders Closing additional paid in equity (December 2011 and December 2012) 90 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 37,557 – 39,621 650 ––––––––––– 37,557 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (8) Reserves Reserves consist of following: Foreign currency translation reserve Employee share option plan 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s (968) 1,630 (1,069) 1,679 ––––––––––– 662 (9) ––––––––––– 610 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 4,601 2,320 7,603 4,777 2,177 10,583 Trade and other payables Trade creditors Accrued expenses and payables Accrued salaries and wages ––––––––––– 14,524 ––––––––––– 17,537 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 41,859 7,596 150 34 42 42,779 10,310 42 38 57 (10) Employee benefits expense Expenses recognised for employee benefits are analysed below: Salaries and other employee costs Social security and other taxes Employee share options expense Pensions – contribution plan Pensions – defined benefits plan ––––––––––– 49,681 ––––––––––– 53,226 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 1,091 5 36 – 860 5 64 2 (11) Finance costs Interest on borrowings Factoring fees Finance charges on leased assets Bank charges ––––––––––– 1,132 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 91 ––––––––––– 931 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (12) Income taxes The tax provision consists of the following: Current US Federal tax US State tax Other than US 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s – 10 49 – – 16 ––––––––––– 59 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Deferred tax/(benefits) US Federal tax US State tax Other than US 32 1 (6) ––––––––––– 28 ––––––––––– 87 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 16 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 36 9 2 ––––––––––– 47 ––––––––––– 63 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The U.S. tax provision calculations include TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions. Additionally, included in the provision are TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions and TRG Customer Solutions Canada Inc., TRG Marketing Solutions Limited Virtual World (Private) Limited, Pakistan, and TRG Philippines Inc.. Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes, as well as net operating losses and tax credit carry forward. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates that will apply to taxable income in the periods the deferred tax item is expected to be settled or realized. The tax effects of the Company’s temporary differences and carry forwards are as follows: Tax effect of deductible/(taxable temporary differences) Deductible temporary differences: – Provisions and write-offs against trade debts – Unpaid accrued expenses/compensation – Net operating losses – Intangibles 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s 6 93 2,914 119 33 82 5,471 88 ––––––––––– 3,132 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Tax effect of taxable differences: – Fixed assets – Intangibles – Prepayments and others (386) (712) (57) ––––––––––– (1,155) (2,682) Deductible temporary differences not recognised ––––––––––– Deferred tax liability (705) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,674 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (549) (823) – ––––––––––– (1,372) (5,108) ––––––––––– (806) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Deferred tax asset on deductible temporary differences (including unused tax losses) has not been recognised in these financial statements, as the management is of the prudent view that it is not probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available in the foreseeable future against which deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses can be utilized. 92 At 31 December 2012, Company’s U.S. federal and state net operating loss carry forwards for income tax purposes are $4.4 million (30 June 2012: $3.8 million) which will begin to expire in 2032. Company’s Canadian subsidiary has net operating loss carry forwards of $12 million (30 June 2012: $12.3 million) for Canadian income tax purposes, expiring over the period 2015 through 2032. Company’s UK subsidiary has net operating loss carry forward of $2.6 million (30 June 2012: $2.6 million). These amounts are based on the income tax returns filed for the year ended 30 June 2012 and estimated amounts for the half year ended 31 December 2012. The timing and manner, in which the group will utilize the U.S. net operating loss carry forwards in any year, or in total, may be limited by provisions of the Internal Revenue Code regarding changes in ownership. Management has evaluated the Company’s tax positions and concluded that the Company had taken no uncertain tax positions that require adjustment to the Combined financial statements. The Group recognizes interest and penalties related to uncertain tax position in income tax expense. As of 31 December 2012; the Company had no provision for interest or penalties related to uncertain tax position. The years 2009-2012 are open to examination by the tax authorities. Reconciliation of effective tax rate 31 December 31 December 2011 2012 Unaudited Audited US$’000 US$’000 Profit/(loss) for the period Income tax expense/(benefit) (2,351) 87 ––––––––––– (2,264) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2011 Unaudited % US$’000 Income tax expense/(benefit) using applicable tax rate State taxes (net of federal tax effect) Effect of tax and exchange rates in foreign jurisdictions Non-deductible expenses Change in unrecognised temporary differences (235) 63 ––––––––––– (172) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 December 2012 Audited % US$’000 34 4 (1) (770) (82) (14) 34 4 (28) (58) (6) 49 (3) (38) 62 862 (30) (16) 51 27 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (4) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 93 87 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (36) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 63 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (13) Cash flows from operating activities Net loss Adjustments for: Depreciation and amortisation Finance costs Provision for retirement benefit expense Stock-based compensation expense Changes in operating assets and liabilities: Trade and other receivables Trade and other payables Deferred revenue/expense Due (to)/from affiliates 2011 Unaudited $000’s 2012 Audited $000’s (2,263) (172) 1,508 1,132 42 150 1,275 931 57 42 (1,492) 3,424 – (188) (5,745) 3,125 (279) 119 ––––––––––– 2,314 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (647) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (14) Related parties – due to and from affiliates During the six months ended 31 December 2011 and 2012, the Company entered into transactions with certain affiliates owned wholly or partially by TRGI, the ultimate parent of IBEX. The transactions took place at fair value. TRG Holdings LLC is 100 per cent. owned by TRGI and acts as a holding company of TRGI businesses in US. Effective from 1 January 2009 to 31 December 2011 intercompany subcontracted services provided among different affiliates were billed through TRG Holdings LLC. TRG BPO Solutions, Inc. is 100 per cent. owned by TRG Holdings LLC. Effective from 1 January 2012 intercompany subcontracted services provided among differences affiliates were billed through TRG Holdings LLC. The related party transactions for the Company as of and for the years ended 30 June 2010, 2011 and 2012 are as follows: Service delivery revenue $000’s TRG Holdings, LLC The Resource Group International Limited Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG Senegal TRG iSKY, Inc. Stratasoft, Inc Balance as of 31 December 2011 Year to 31 December 2011 (Unaudited) Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $000’s $000’s $000’s Total due to affiliates long term $000’s 967 2,336 1,394 – (1,082) – 246 – – 638 – – 193 – – – – – – – – 38 – – 943 9,331 96 526 – 20 444 – (322) – – – – (8) – – (25) – – – – – (1,218) – – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,044 2,374 12,754 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 94 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (355) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,300) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Service delivery revenue $000’s Due from affiliates: TRG Holdings, LLC TRG BPO Solutions, Ir. The Resource Group International Limited Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG Senegal TRG iSky, Inc. Due to affiliates: Stratasoft, Inc Balance as of 31 December 2012 Year to 31 December 2012 (Audited) Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $000’s $000’s $000’s Total due to affiliates long term $000’s – 1,304 – 2,825 39 1,999 – – (1,082) – – 251 – – 284 – – 283 – – – – – – – – – 955 10,604 162 67 – 20 492 (63) – – – – (7) – – – – – – – (1,395) – – – ––––––––––– 2,122 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 2,825 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 14,338 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (21) ––––––––––– (91) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (2,477) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (15) Subsequent events Please refer to Part 4 Additional Information for details of the following subsequent events: – changes in the share capital of the Company (paragraph 2 of Part 4); – adoption of an employee share options plan ( paragraph 4 of Part 4); – formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 11 of Part 4); and – tax indemnification agreement related to the formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 12.8 of Part 4). 95 PART 3D UNAUDITED INTERIM FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED 31 MARCH 2013 Combined Statements of Comprehensive Income For the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 Revenue Cost of sales Notes 2012 Unaudited $’000’s 2013 Unaudited $’000’s 3 27,128 (23,066) 35,433 (29,242) ––––––––––– Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses 4,026 (3,853) ––––––––––– 209 1,443 (327) – – (452) (15,670) – 11 ––––––––––– Loss before income taxes Income tax expense 12 (118) – ––––––––––– Net loss (118) Other comprehensive loss: Foreign currency translation adjustment 46 ––––––––––– Total comprehensive loss attributable to equity holders (72) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 96 6,191 (4,748) ––––––––––– Operating profit Other expenses: Finance costs Affiliate balances written off Other income ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (14,679) (9) ––––––––––– (14,688) 159 ––––––––––– (14,529) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Financial Position As at 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 Notes Assets Non current assets: Goodwill Other intangible assets Property, plant and equipment Other non-current assets Total non current assets Current assets: Trade and other receivables Deferred expenses Due from affiliates Cash and cash equivalents 2012 Unaudited $’000’s 2013 Unaudited $’000’s 8,644 748 3,900 2,030 8,644 570 3,295 2,276 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 15,322 14,785 20,370 1,426 12,906 2,279 26,746 480 306 3,260 4 5 Total current assets ––––––––––– 36,981 ––––––––––– Total assets 52,303 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Equity and liabilities Share capital and reserves Share capital Additional paid in capital Other reserves Retained loss 6 7 8 1,464 37,557 783 (21,862) 6,443 705 404 582 2,150 255 676 806 – 682 1,601 383 653 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 4,772 4,125 12,796 560 14,068 1,556 609 16,830 178 17,412 480 109 ––––––––––– 29,589 ––––––––––– Total liabilities 34,361 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Total equity and liabilities 52,303 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 97 3,844 40,271 844 (38,516) ––––––––––– 9 Total current liabilities 45,577 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 17,942 Total non current liabilities Current liabilities: Line of credit Obligation under finance lease – current portion Trade and other payables Deferred revenue – current portion Due to affiliates – current portion 30,792 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Total equity Non current liabilities: Deferred tax liabilities Deferred revenue – non-current portion Obligation under finance lease – non-current portion Due to affiliates – non-current portion Retirement benefits obligations Other ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35,009 ––––––––––– 39,134 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 45,577 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Changes in Equity For the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 Other reserves As at 31 December 2011 (Unaudited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 March 2012 (Unaudited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 30 June 2012 (Audited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 December 2012 (Audited) Net loss Other comprehensive loss Total comprehensive income for the year Issue of share capital Employee share based payment options Transactions with owners As at 31 March 2013 (Unaudited) Issued, subscribed and paid-up capital Amount $000’s Additional paid in capital $’000’s Employee share option plan $’000’s Foreign currency translation reserve $’000’s Retained loss $’000’s Total equity $000’s 1,464 – – 37,557 – – 1,630 – – (968) – 46 (21,744) (118) – 17,939 (118) 46 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 46 (118) – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– – 75 ––––––––––– 75 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 37,557 – – 1,705 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 2,064 – – – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 2,064 (68) ––––––––––– (68) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 39,621 – – 1,637 – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – 650 – – – ––––––––––– – – ––––––––––– 650 42 ––––––––––– 42 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,464 – – 40,271 – – 1,679 – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (922) – (86) ––––––––––– (86) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,008) – (61) ––––––––––– (61) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (1,069) – 159 – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (21,862) (1,731) – ––––––––––– (1,731) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,593) (235) – ––––––––––– (235) – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (23,828) (14,688) – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – 2,380 – – – – 159 – (14,688) – – ––––––––––– 2,380 ––––––––––– 3,844 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 75 ––––––––––– 75 ––––––––––– 1,754 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (910) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 98 – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (38,516) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (72) 75 ––––––––––– 75 ––––––––––– 17,942 (1,731) (86) ––––––––––– (1,817) 2,064 (68) ––––––––––– 1,996 ––––––––––– 18,121 (235) (61) ––––––––––– (296) 650 42 ––––––––––– 692 ––––––––––– 18,517 (14,688) 159 ––––––––––– (14,529) 2,380 75 ––––––––––– 2,455 ––––––––––– 6,443 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Combined Statements of Cashflows For the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 Cash flows from operating activities: Cash generated used in operations Interest paid Taxes paid Notes 2012 Unaudited $’000’s 2013 Unaudited $’000’s 13 106 (327) (55) (574) (451) (40) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Net cash used in operating activities (276) (1,074) Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of property and equipment Additions to intangible assets (216) (47) (296) – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Net cash used in investing activities (263) (296) Cash flows from financing activities: Borrowings on line of credit Grants received Payments on capital lease obligations 501 142 (164) 2,232 – (207) Net cash generated from financing activities Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash at beginning of period Cash at end of period ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 479 47 2,025 151 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (13) 2,292 806 2,454 ––––––––––– 5 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The accompanying notes are an integral part of this historical financial information 99 2,279 ––––––––––– 3,260 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Notes to the Historical Financial Information For the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 (1) Nature of the business IBEX Group is a global portfolio of companies in the contact center and related business process outsourcing (BPO) business operating from the United States, Philippines, United Kingdom, Pakistan and Senegal. Service offerings include customer care support, business and consumer inbound and outbound telesales and technical support services. IBEX Group also offers enabling technology solutions including Interactive Voice Response (IVR). (2) Basis of preparation The unaudited combined historical financial information for the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 and as at those dates has been prepared for inclusion in the AIM Admission Document dated 24 June 2013 on the basis of preparation and under the accounting policies set out in notes 2 and 3 to the audited combined historical financial information included in Part 3B. This unaudited combined historical financial information does not constitute statutory accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Companies Act 2006, is not a set of general purpose financial statements under paragraph three of IFRS 1 – First Time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards and does not comply with IAS 34 – Interim Financial Reporting. The Directors of the Company are responsible for preparation of this unaudited combined historical financial information. (3) Operating segments This historical financial information has been prepared of the basis on a single reportable segment. Whilst the group operates in different locations, there are no multiple products or lines of services upon which the results reported to chief operating decision maker are segregated and analysed. Revenue Gross margin Operating profit US GAAP to IFRS adjustments 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 27,128 4,026 209 – 35,433 6,191 1,443 – ––––––––––– Reportable operating profit 209 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 1,443 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 91.14 per cent. and 90.74 per cent. of the total revenue was earned from customers in United States of America for the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 2013 respectively. 100 The following table summarises those non related party customers with revenue or accounts receivable in excess of 5 per cent. total revenue or total receivables for the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 2013 respectively. The revenue analysis below does not form part of the Group’s segmental reporting but is provided voluntarily. 31 March 2012 (Unaudited) Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $000’s % $000’s % Client Client Client Client 1 2 3 4 Other 3,419 6,396 4,990 4,173 13% 24% 18% 15% 2,216 3,191 4,824 2,654 12% 18% 27% 15% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 18,978 8,150 70% 30% 12,885 4,940 72% 28% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 27,128 100% 17,825 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 March 2013 (Unaudited) Revenue Accounts receivable Percentage Percentage Amount of total Amount of total $000’s % $000’s % Client Client Client Client Other 2 3 4 5 10,978 9,553 3,253 2,757 31% 27% 9% 8% 7,032 9,634 2,074 1,094 28% 38% 8% 4% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 26,541 8,892 75% 25% 19,834 5,247 78% 22% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 35,433 100% 25,081 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 100% ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Client 1 does not represent 5 per cent. of revenues or receivables as of 31 March 2013. Above clients are Fortune 100 and/or Fortune 500 companies. Details of segment assets and liabilities can be found in the combined statement of financial position. There are no differences between US GAAP and IFRS. Revenues are attributed to geographic areas based upon the location in which the sale originated. IBEX Global Solutions Plc is domiciled in the United Kingdom. All revenues from external customers arose in the United States of America in each of the reported periods. Non-current assets located outside of the United Kingdom totalled $15.3 million and $14.8 million for the three months to 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013 respectively. 101 (4) Trade and other receivables Trade and other receivables consist of the following: Trade receivables – gross Less: provision for doubtful debts Trade receivables – net Prepayments and other Deposits Notes receivable 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 18,112 (287) 25,517 (436) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 17,825 1,804 240 501 25,081 1,520 145 – ––––––––––– 20,370 ––––––––––– 26,746 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 13 2,228 250 2,998 (5) Cash and bank balances Cash and cash equivalents consist of the following: Balances with banks in: – current accounts – deposit accounts Cash in hand ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2,2241 38 3,248 12 ––––––––––– 2,279 (6) ––––––––––– 3,260 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 1,464 – 1,464 2,380 Share capital Opening share capital (December 2011 and December 2012) Additional contributions from equity holders Closing additional paid in equity (March 2012 and March 2013) ––––––––––– 1,464 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 3,844 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– All shares are equally eligible to receive dividends and the repayment of capital, and represent one vote at the Annual General Meeting. (7) Additional paid in equity 2012 Unaudited $000’s Additional paid in equity (March 2012 and March 2013) 102 37,557 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2013 Unaudited $000’s 40,271 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (8) Reserves Reserves consist of following: Foreign currency translation reserve Employee share option plan 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s (922) 1,705 (910) 1,754 ––––––––––– 783 (9) ––––––––––– 844 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 3,778 2,584 7,706 4,989 2,274 10,149 Trade and other payables Trade creditors Accrued expenses and payables Accrued salaries and wages ––––––––––– 14,068 ––––––––––– 17,412 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 20,882 75 33 26,986 75 29 (10) Employee benefits expense Expenses recognised for employee benefits are analysed below: Salaries and other employee costs Employee share options expense Pensions – defined benefits plan ––––––––––– 20,990 ––––––––––– 27,090 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 309 17 1 427 24 1 (11) Finance costs Interest on borrowings Finance charges on leased assets Bank charges ––––––––––– 327 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 103 ––––––––––– 452 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (12) Income taxes The tax provision consists of the following: Current US Federal tax US State tax Other than US 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s – – – – – (9) ––––––––––– – Deferred tax/(benefits) US Federal tax US State tax Other than US ––––––––––– (9) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – – – – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – ––––––––––– (9) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– The U.S. tax provision calculations include TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions. Additionally, included in the provision are TRG Customer Solutions Inc. trading as IBEX Global Solutions and TRG Customer Solutions Canada Inc., TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and Virtual World (Private) Limited, Pakistan, and TRG Philippines Inc.. Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes, as well as net operating losses and tax credit carry forward. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates that will apply to taxable income in the periods the deferred tax item is expected to be settled or realized. The tax effects of the Company’s temporary differences and carry forwards are as follows: Tax effect of deductible/(taxable temporary differences) Deductible temporary differences: – Provisions and write-offs against trade debts – Unpaid accrued expenses/compensation – Net operating losses – Intangibles 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s 6 93 2,914 119 33 82 5,471 88 ––––––––––– 3,132 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Tax effect of taxable differences: – Fixed assets – Intangibles – Prepayments and others (386) (712) (57) ––––––––––– (1,155) (2,682) Deductible temporary differences not recognised ––––––––––– Deferred tax liability (705) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,674 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (549) (823) – ––––––––––– (1,372) (5,108) ––––––––––– (806) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Deferred tax asset on deductible temporary differences (including unused tax losses) has not been recognised in this financial information, as the management is of the prudent view that it is not probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available in the foreseeable future against which deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses can be utilized. 104 At 31 March 2013, Group’s US federal and state net operating loss carry forwards for income tax purposes are $17.4 million (31 December 2012: $4.4 million) which will begin to expire in 2032. Group’s Canadian subsidiary has net operating loss carry forwards of $3 million (31 December 2012: $12 million) for Canadian income tax purposes, expiring over the period 2015 through 2032. Group’s UK subsidiary has net operating loss carry forwards of $2.6 million (31 December 2012: $2.6 million). These amounts are based on the income tax returns filed for the year ended 30 June 2012 and estimated amounts for the nine months ended 31 March 2013. The timing and manner, in which the group will utilize the US net operating loss carry forwards in any year, or in total, may be limited by provisions of the Internal Revenue Code regarding changes in ownership. Management has evaluated the Group’s tax positions and concluded that the Group had taken no uncertain tax positions that require adjustment to the consolidated financial statements. The Group recognises interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense. As of 31 March 2013; the Group had no provision for interest or penalties related to uncertain tax positions. The years 2009-2012 are open to examination by the tax authorities. Reconciliation of effective tax rate Loss for the period Income tax expense 31 March 2012 Unaudited US$’000 31 March 2013 Unaudited US$’000 (118) – (14,679) (9) ––––––––––– (118) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 March 2012 Unaudited % US$’000 Income tax benefit using applicable tax rate State taxes (net of federal tax effect) Effect of tax and exchange rates in foreign jurisdictions Non-deductible expenses Change in unrecognised temporary differences (14,688) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 31 March 2013 Unaudited % US$’000 34 4 (40) (4) 34 4 (4,939) (523) 70 (12) (96) (83) 14 113 (1) (20) (17) 144 2,855 2,454 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– – – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 105 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (9) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (13) Cash flows from operating activities Net loss Adjustments for: Depreciation and amortisation Finance costs Affiliate balances written off Income tax provision Provision for retirement benefit expense Stock-based compensation expense Changes in operating assets and liabilities: Trade and other receivables Trade and other payables Deferred revenue/expense Due (to)/from affiliates 2012 Unaudited $000’s 2013 Unaudited $000’s (118) (14,688) 695 327 – – 33 75 510 452 15,670 9 30 75 (291) (567) – (48) (2,374) (140) (11) (116) ––––––––––– 106 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (574) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (14) Related parties – due to and from affiliates During the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 2013, the Group entered into transactions with certain affiliates owned wholly or partially by TRGI, the ultimate parent of IBEX. The transactions took place at fair value. TRG BPO Solutions, Inc. is 100 per cent. owned by TRG Holdings LLC. Effective from 1 January 2012 intercompany subcontracted services provided among differences affiliates were billed through TRG Holdings LLC. The related party transactions for the Group as of and for the three months ended 31 March 2012 and 2013 are as follows: Service delivery revenue $000’s TRG Holdings, LLC TRG BPO Solutions, Inc. The Resource Group International Limited Alert Inc. TRG Marketing Services Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG iSKY, Inc. Stratasoft, Inc Balance as of 31 March 2012 Year to 31 March 2012 (Unaudited) Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $000’s $000’s $000’s Total due to affiliates long term $000’s – 4,491 – 5,193 39 1,852 – – (1,082) – 126 – – 572 – 124 – – – – – – – – – – 957 9,332 118 59 – 491 – (283) – – – – (305) – (21) – – – – – (1,068) – – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,313 5,193 12,848 (609) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 106 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (2,150) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– Service delivery revenue $000’s Due from affiliates: TRG BPO Solutions, Inc. The Resource Group International Limited Alert Inc. Digital Globe Services TRG SATMAP Inc. TRG Private Ltd. TRG iSKY, Inc. Balance as of 31 March 2013 Year ended 31 March 2013 (Unaudited) Service Total due Total due delivery from affiliates to affiliates expense current current $000’s $000’s $000’s Total due to affiliates long term $000’s 5,408 5,987 – – – – 121 – 134 – 110 – – – – – – – 35 133 – – 138 (109) – – – – – – – – (1,601) – ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– 5,773 5,987 306 (109) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (1,601) ––––––––––– ––––––––––– (15) Group re-organisation On 29 March 2013, internally generated intellectual property (Technology) with a carrying value of nil in IBEX US was sold to The Resource Group International Limited in exchange for a promissory note worth $7.5 million. Under the IFRS rules for common control accounting, no gain or loss was recognised in the financial information. On the same date, IBEX US assigned the promissory note to TRG Holdings LLC. On 30 March 2013, IBEX US and IBEX Philippines wrote off its inter-company balances with other affiliates as follows: Unaudited $000’s Due from affiliates (net) TRG Holdings LLC Alert, Inc. TRG Marketing Services, Inc. SKY, Inc. BPO Solutions, Inc. 461 944 10,605 390 3,291 ––––––––––– Total 15,961 Due to affiliates Stratasoft, Inc. (21) ––––––––––– Net write-off amount 15,670 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– On 30 March 2013, The Resource Group International Limited assumed liabilities worth $2.38 million and $1.89 million, that were payable by IBEX UK and IBEX Senegal respectively to other affiliated TRG entities. On the same date, IBEX UK and IBEX Senegal issued shares to The Resource Group International Limited for $2.38 million and $1.89 million respectively to convert those debts in to equity. 107 IBEX US was previously a 100 per cent. subsidiary of TRG Holdings LLC (US). On 31 March 2013, as a part of group reorganisation, TRG Holdings, LLC distributed shares in IBEX US to its parent The Resource Group International Limited. On the same date, The Resource Group International Limited transferred shares in the following entities to IBEX Global Solutions Limited: Unaudited $000’s IBEX US IBEX Marketing UK Virtual World Pakistan IBEX Philippines IBEX Senegal 30,552 2,381 545 12,532 1,987 ––––––––––– Total 47,997 ––––––––––– ––––––––––– IBEX Global Solutions Limited issued shares worth $47.99 million to The Resource Group International Limited as consideration. Assets and liabilities of the above entities were recognised in the combined financial statements at their carrying amounts (at the date of transfer) as the share exchange took place between entities under common control. No adjustments have been made in this combined historical financial information for the investment and related share capital in IBEX Global Solutions Limited as this would be eliminated in any consolidation. IBEX Global Solutions Limited was formed on 26 March 2013 by The Resource Group International Limited with a share capital of $21,788. It serves as a holding company for IBEX entities. IBEX Global Solutions Limited issued additional share capital of $1 million on 31 March 2013 in exchange for prepaid asset received from TRG International Limited. This prepaid asset represents advance payment made to another affiliate (SATMAP, Inc.) for services to be used by IBEX. IBEX Global Solutions, Limited (UK) formed IBEX Global Solutions Private Limited (Pakistan) and IBEX Global Solutions Cyprus (formerly Lovercius Consultants Limited) on 31 March 2013. (16) Subsequent events Please refer to Part 4 Additional Information for details of the following subsequent events: – changes in the share capital of the Company (paragraph 2 of Part 4); – adoption of an employee share options plan ( paragraph 4 of Part 4); – formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 11 of Part 4); and – tax indemnification agreement related to the formation of the Group and corporate structure (paragraph 12.8 of Part 4). 108 PART 4 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 1. 1.1 THE COMPANY The Company is incorporated and trades under the name IBEX Global Solutions PLC. 1.2 The Company is domiciled in the United Kingdom and was incorporated and registered in England and Wales on 26 March 2013 as a private limited company with the name IBEX Global Solutions Limited and registered number 08462510. On 4 June 2013, following a special resolution passed by the Shareholders, the Company was re-registered as a public company. The liability of its members is limited. 1.3 The Company is governed by and its securities were created under the Act. 1.4 The Company’s registered office is located at 3rd Floor, 5 Lloyds Avenue, London EC3N 3AE and its principal place of business is at 1700 Pennsylvania Avenue, Suite 560, Washington DC, 20006 USA. The telephone numbers of the Company’s registered address and principal place of business are +44 (0)800 043 4239 and +1 202 289 9898 respectively. 1.5 The Company has no administrative, management or supervisory bodies other than the Board of Directors, the remuneration committee and the audit committee, all of whose members are Directors. Amicorp (UK) Secretaries Limited of 3rd Floor, 5 Lloyds Avenue, London EC3N 3AE, has been appointed as corporate secretary and administrator of the Company. 1.6 The Group’s auditors during the period covered by the Historical Financial Information were (i) for the three years ended 30 June 2012, KPMG LLP, and (ii) for the six months ended 31 December 2012, Grant Thornton UK LLP, who are members of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales. 1.7 Details of the Company’s subsidiaries are set out in the table below: Name IBEX Inc. TRG Marketing Solutions Limited Virtual World Private Limited TRG Philippines Inc. The Resource Group Senegal SA IBEX Global Solutions Private Limited IBEX Global Europe S.a r.l Lovercius Consultants Limited TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc. TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc. TRG Customer Solutions (Philippines) Inc. Function USA operating company UK operating company Pakistan operating company Philippines services company Senegal services company Pakistan services company Intellectual property licensing company Off-shore billing entity Canada Non-Trading Company Philippines services company Philippines dormant company * Please see notes below: 109 Country of Incorporation (and residence, if different) Delaware, USA Per cent. interest 100 Direct/ Indirect Direct England 100 Direct Pakistan 100* Direct Philippines 100* Direct Senegal 100* Direct Pakistan 100* Direct Luxembourg 100 Direct Cyprus Canada 100 100 Direct Indirect Philippines 100* Indirect Philippines 100 Indirect The Company holds 409,995 shares in the capital of TRG Philippines Inc. and each of the following directors of TRG Philippines Inc. hold one share each: Steve Kezirian, Mohammed Khaishgi, Nauman Nizim, Brian Heiner and Nestor Dantes. TRG Philippines Inc. holds 8,699,995 shares in the capital of TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc. and each of the following directors of TRG Philippines Inc. hold one share each: Steve Kezirian, Mohammed Khaishgi, Nauman Nizim, Brian Heiner and Nestor Dantes. The Company holds 93,309 shares in The Resource Group Senegal SA and Famara Ibrahima Sagna holds five shares. The directors of IBEX Global Solutions Private Limited, Nadeem Elahi and Syed Adnan each hold one share in the capital of IBEX Global Solutions Private Limited (being the entire issued share capital of IBEX Global Solutions Private Limited) on trust for the Company. The Company holds 3,257,680 shares in the capital of Virtual World Private Limited and each of the directors of Virtual World Private Limited, namely Nadeem Elahi and Waseem Ahmed, hold one share. 2. 2.1 SHARE CAPITAL OF THE GROUP The Company was incorporated with one ordinary share of £1.00, subscribed to by Chalfen Nominees Limited. On 26 March 2013, Chalfen Nominees Limited transferred the subscriber share to TRGI. 2.2 On 31 March 2013, the Company received an application for 1,566,470 ordinary shares of £1.00 each from TRGI in exchange for the transfer by TRGI of the legal and beneficial ownership of 1,566,470 ordinary shares of £1.00 each in the capital of TRG Marketing Solutions Limited. On the same date, the sole director of the Group, Zia Chishti, approved the allotment and issue of 1,566,470 ordinary shares of £100 each to TRGI. 2.3 On 31 March 2013, the Company received a second application from TRGI for 30,683,484 ordinary shares of £1.00 each in exchange for the transfer by TRGI of the following assets to the Company, effective as of 31 March 2013: 2.3.1 93,309 shares of 1,000 Francs each in the capital of The Resource Group Senegal, which, save for five shares held by Famara Ibrahima Sagna, comprise the entire issued share capital of The Resource Group Senegal SA; 2.3.2 409,995 common stock in TRG Philippines Inc. of PP.100 each, together with the beneficial ownership of five shares in the capital of TRG Philippines Inc. held on trust for TRGI by TRG Philippines Inc.’s directors, which together comprise the entire issued share capital of TRG Philippines Inc. pursuant to a deed of assignment of shares of stock entered into between (1) TRGI and (2) the Group dated 31 March 2013; 2.3.3 3,257,680 shares of Rs.10 each in the capital of Virtual World Private Limited, together with the beneficial ownership of two shares in Virtual World Private Limited held on trust for TRGI by the directors of Virtual World, which together comprise the entire issued share capital of Virtual World Private Limited; 2.3.4 1,500 shares of US$0.0001 each in the capital of IBEX Inc. which comprise the entire issued share capital of IBEX Inc.; 2.3.5 €17,000 to be applied towards the Group’s costs of incorporating a Luxembourg subsidiary which has a paid up capital of US$21,788; and 2.3.6 US$1,000,000 in prepaid SATMAP services pursuant to a first draft amendment to the commercial schedule dated 31 March 2013 and a promissory note from TRGI of even date in the sum of US$1,000,000 due in full on 30 June 2017 with an annual interest rate of 1.95 per cent. per annum. 2.4 On 31 March 2013, the sole director of the Company, Zia Chishti, approved the allotment and issue of 30,683,484 ordinary shares of £1.00 in connection with the application detailed in paragraph 2.3 above. 2.5 On 31 May 2013, by means of a board decision of the sole director and a written resolution of the sole member, the Company adopted a new set of articles of association and divided its shares with a nominal value of £1 each into: 2.5.1 one ordinary share of £0.01 each in the capital of the Company; and 2.5.2 one deferred share of £0.99 each in the capital of the Company (a “Deferred Share”). 110 2.6 On 31 May 2013, the Company received an application for 100 ordinary shares of £0.01 each from Mohammedalla Khaishgi at par for the purpose of funding a buy-back of the Deferred Shares. On the same date, by means of a board decision of the sole director and a written resolution of the sole member, the Company granted its directors a general and unconditional authority under section 551 of the Act to allot shares in the Company up to an aggregate nominal amount of £1. Thereafter, 100 ordinary shares of £0.01 each were issued to Mr Khaishgi for an aggregate subscription price of £1. 2.7 On 31 May 2013, by means of a board decision of the sole director and a written resolution of the eligible shareholder, the Company agreed to purchase 32,249,955 Deferred Shares from TRGI for a total consideration of £1. On the same date, the Company entered into an off-market share purchase agreement with TRGI to effect such transfer of Deferred Shares and upon completion of such share buyback, the Deferred Shares were cancelled. 2.8 On 31 May 2013, Mr Khaishgi sold his interest in 100 ordinary shares of £0.01 each in the Company to TRGI for aggregate consideration of £1. 2.9 The issued share capital of the Company immediately prior to the Placing and Admission was as follows: £ 322,500.55 Number 32,250,055 Ordinary Shares 2.10 The issued share capital of the Company following the Placing and Admission will be as follows: £ 395,544 Number 39,554,400 Ordinary Shares 2.11 Of the 32,250,055 Ordinary Shares allotted and issued by the Company prior to Admission, 99.99 per cent. of the Ordinary Shares allotted and issued during the period were paid for with assets other than cash. 2.12 The Placing will result in the allotment and issue of 7,304,345 New Ordinary Shares, diluting existing holders of Ordinary Shares by 18 per cent. 2.13 Section 561(1) of the Act gives the Shareholders pre-emption rights on any issue of shares by the Group to the extent not disapplied by a special resolution passed pursuant to section 570 of the Act. Details of the current section 571 of the Act disapplication are set out in paragraph 2.14 below. 2.14 By ordinary and special resolutions passed on 20 June 2013: 2.14.1 the Directors were authorised, conditional on Admission, for the purposes of section 551 of the Act to allot relevant securities of the Company: (a) up to an aggregate nominal amount of £73,043.45 in respect of the New Ordinary Shares; and (b) otherwise than pursuant to sub-paragraph 2.14.1(a) above, up to one third of the issued share capital of the Company immediately following Admission; such authorisation expiring on the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company (unless previously renewed, varied or revoked by the Company in a general meeting); and 2.14.2 the Directors were authorised, conditional on Admission and subject to the passing of the resolution summarised in paragraph 2.14.1 of this Part, to allot equity securities of the Company pursuant to: (a) the authority summarised in paragraph 2.14.1(a) above, and (b) otherwise than pursuant to paragraph 2.14.2(a) above, up to 20 per cent. of the issued share capital of the Company immediately following Admission, as if section 561(a) of the Act did not apply to such allotments, such authorisation expiring on the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company (unless previously renewed, varied or revoked by the Company in a general meeting). 2.15 It is anticipated the Placing Shares will be issued on the date of Admission. 111 3. 3.1 SECURITIES BEING OFFERED/ADMITTED The Ordinary Shares are ordinary shares of £0.01 each in the capital of the Company and were issued in British Pounds Sterling. 3.2 The Ordinary Shares may be held in certificated form or under the CREST system, which is a paperless settlement procedure enabling securities to be evidenced and transferred, otherwise than by a written instrument in accordance with the CREST Regulations. The Company’s registrars, Capita Registrars Limited, are responsible for keeping the Company’s register of members. 3.3 The dividend and voting rights attaching to the Ordinary Shares are set out in paragraph 6.2 of this Part 4. 3.4 The par value of each Ordinary Share is £0.01. 3.5 The Company has no issued Ordinary Shares that are not fully paid up. 3.6 The Ordinary Shares have no right to share in the profits of the Group other than through a dividend, distribution or return of capital; further details of which are set out in paragraph 6.3 of this Part 4. 3.7 Each Ordinary Share is entitled on a pari passu basis with all other issued Ordinary Shares to share in any surplus on a liquidation of the Company. 3.8 The Ordinary Shares have no redemption or conversion provisions. 3.9 The Ordinary Shares are freely transferable provided that such shares are fully paid, the Company has no lien over such shares, the instrument of transfer is duly stamped, is in favour of not more than four joint transferees and is in respect of only one class of shares. 3.10 No person has made a public takeover bid for the Company’s issued share capital. 3.11 A shareholder is required pursuant to Disclosure and Transparency Rule 5 of the Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the FCA, to notify the Group when he acquires or disposes of a major proportion of the voting rights of the Group equal to or in excess of 3 per cent. of the nominal value of that share capital. 3.12 The Company is not, until 30 September 2013, subject to the Code as its place of central management and control is in the USA. Accordingly, the rules contained the Code governing substantial acquisitions of shares will not apply to the Company at Admission. However, certain protections under Rule 9 of the Code have been incorporated into the Articles. See paragraph 6 of this Part 4 for further details. Any party intending to acquire all or a substantial part of the issued share capital of the Company will not be obliged to comply with the provisions of the Code as to announcements, equality of treatment for shareholders as to the value and type of consideration offered, and will not be subjected to the scrutiny and sanctions of the Panel. In addition, in the event such party acquires at least nine-tenths in value of the issued share capital of the Company to which its offer relates it may, in accordance with the procedure set out in section 979 of the Act, require the holders of any shares it has not acquired to sell them subject to the terms of the offer, and such Shareholders may in turn require such party to purchase such shares on the same terms. With effect from 30 September 2013, the ‘place of central management and control’ test will no longer apply to companies which have their registered offices in the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and which have securities admitted to trading on a multilateral trading facility (such as AIM) in the UK. This will have the effect of bringing the Company within the ambit of the Code even though its place of central management and control is in the USA. 3.13 Save as disclosed in paragraphs 2, 4 and 8 of this Part 4: 3.13.1 no share or loan capital of the Company has been issued or is proposed to be issued; 3.13.2 there are currently no outstanding convertible securities, exchangeable securities or securities with warrants issued by the Company; 3.13.3 there are no shares in the Company not representing capital; 112 3.13.4 there are no shares in the Company held by or on behalf of the Company itself or by subsidiaries of the Company; 3.13.5 there are no acquisition rights and/or obligations over authorised but unissued share capital of the Company and the Company has made no undertaking to increase its share capital; 3.13.6 no person has any preferential or subscription rights for any share capital of the Company; and 3.13.7 no share or loan capital of the Company or any member of the Company is under option or agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option. 4. TERMS OF THE OPTIONS/CONVERSION RIGHTS 4.1 2013 Stock Plan The Company intends to adopt an employee stock option plan (the 2013 Stock Plan) to enable certain executives and employees of the Group to be granted options to acquire Ordinary Shares and restricted stock awards (Options) in the capital of the Company. No Options have been granted under the 2013 Stock Plan as at the date of this document. The main features of the 2013 Stock Plan (which is not approved by HM Revenue and Customs) are summarised below: Eligibility Options may be granted under the 2013 Stock Plan at the discretion of the Board or a committee of the Board to employees, directors, and consultants of the Group. Scheme limit The number of grants that may be made pursuant to the 2013 Stock Plan are limited in the aggregate to 982,004 Ordinary Shares. These Ordinary Shares have been reserved by the Company for potential grants made under the 2013 Stock Plan. Grant of options Options may be granted at any time, at the discretion of the Board or a committee of the Board provided that the grant of such Option would not breach the terms of any share dealing or corporate governance code adopted by the Company or the AIM Rules from time to time or applicable or regulation, or exceed the number of shares authorised and reserved for the 2013 Stock Plan. Exercise price The exercise price payable per Ordinary Shares is: ● in the case of an employee of the Company owning 10 (ten) per cent. or more of the voting power of all classes of share of the Company or its parent or any company in the Group, the exercise of the Option shall be equal to or greater than 110 per cent. of the fair market value of the ordinary shares on the date the Option is granted; and ● in the case of any other employee, equal to or greater than 100 per cent. of the fair market value. The ‘fair market value’ shall, where possible, be the closing price per Ordinary Share reported in the Wall Street Journal for the date of grant. Amendment and Termination The 2013 Stock Plan may be altered or terminated at any time, save that a termination or amendment which materially and adversely affects or impairs the rights of subsisting option holders shall not be made unless the option holder consents. 113 Change of Control In the event of a change of control of the Company, the administrator of the 2013 Stock Plan has discretion as to how such options are determined. 4.2 TRGI Stock Plan TRGI and the Company adopted an employee stock option plan on 4 June 2013 (the TRGI Stock Plan) to enable certain executives and employees of the Group to be granted options by TRGI to acquire Ordinary Shares and restricted stock awards (TRGI Options) over 4,301,890 Ordinary Shares held by TRGI. The main features of the TRGI Stock Plan (which is not approved by HM Revenue and Customs) are summarised below: Eligibility Options may be granted under the TRGI Stock Plan at the discretion of the board of TRGI or a committee of the board of TRGI to employees, directors, and consultants of the Group. Scheme limit The number of grants that may be made pursuant to the TRGI Stock Plan are limited in the aggregate to 4,301,890 Ordinary Shares held by TRGI. Grant of options Options may be granted at any time, at the discretion of the board of TRGI or a committee of the board of TRGI provided that the grant of such TRGI Option would not breach the terms of any share dealing or corporate governance code adopted by the Company or the AIM Rules from time to time or applicable or regulation, or exceed the number of shares authorised and reserved for the TRGI Stock Plan. Exercise price The exercise price payable per Ordinary Shares is: ● in the case of an employee of the Company owning 10 (ten) per cent. or more of the voting power of all classes of share of the Company or its parent or any company in the Group, the exercise of the Option shall be equal to or greater than 110 per cent. of the fair market value of the Ordinary Shares on the date the Option is granted; and ● in the case of any other employee, equal to or greater than 100 per cent. of the fair market value. The “fair market value” shall, where possible, be the closing price per share reported in the Wall Street Journal for the date of grant. Amendment and Termination The TRGI Stock Plan may be altered or terminated at any time, save that a termination or amendment which materially and adversely affects or impairs the rights of subsisting Option holders shall not be made unless the Option holder consents. Change of Control In the event of a change of control of TRGI or the Company, the administrator of the TRGI Stock Plan has discretion as to how such options are determined. 5. 5.1 CONTROL OF THE COMPANY To the best of the knowledge of the Company, there are no persons except TRGI who directly or indirectly control the Company, where control means owning 30 per cent. or more of the voting 114 rights attaching to the share capital of the Company. The Company has entered into a relationship agreement with TRGI to regulate their relationship. A summary of such relationship agreement is set out at paragraph 12.6 of this Part 4. 5.2 The Company is not aware of any arrangements which may at a subsequent date result in a change in control of the Company. 6. ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION The Company’s articles were adopted pursuant to a special resolution of the Company passed on 3 June 2013. The Company’s articles contain provisions (among others) to the following effect: 6.1 Objects There are no express objects or restrictions on objects in the Company’s articles, with the effect that the objects of the Company are unrestricted in accordance with section 31 of the Act. 6.2 Voting 6.2.1 Subject to any rights or restrictions as to voting attached to any class of shares, at any general meeting on a show of hands and on a poll every member who is present in person and every person present who is the duly authorised representative of one or more corporations and every member who is present by proxy has the number of votes provided by the Act. In summary, that act provides that on a vote on a resolution on a show of hands: 6.3 (a) each member present has one vote; (b) every proxy present who has been duly appointed by one or more members entitled to vote on the resolution has one vote unless the proxy is appointed by more than one such member and is instructed by one or more of those members to vote for the resolution and by one or more other of those members to vote against it. In that case, the proxy has one vote for and one vote against the resolution (and the articles provide that for this purpose where a proxy is given discretion how to vote, this must be treated as an instruction by the member to vote in the way that the proxy elects to exercise that discretion); and (c) a person present as a duly authorised representative of a corporation is entitled to exercise the same rights as the member would be entitled to (see (a) above) and where a corporation authorises more than one person, each person has the same rights as the corporation would have. 6.2.2 On a resolution on a poll every member has one vote in respect of each share and any or all of the voting rights of the member may be exercised by one or more duly appointed proxies or by one or more duly appointed corporate representatives. 6.2.3 A member is not entitled to vote if any calls or other monies due in respect of his shares remain unpaid and a member may be disenfranchised where he, or a person appearing to be interested in shares fails to comply with a notice from the Company under section 793 of the Act (section 793 notice) which may require him to indicate the capacity in which he holds the shares or any interest in them. Dividends and distributions 6.3.1 Dividends may be declared by ordinary resolution but must not in any event exceed the amount recommended by the Directors. 6.3.2 Subject to the rights of persons (if any) entitled to shares with special dividend rights, all dividends will be paid according to the amounts paid up (otherwise than in advance of calls) on the nominal value of the shares on which the dividend is paid. 6.3.3 The Directors may from time to time pay to the members such interim dividends as appear to them to be justified by the profits of the Company. If any member or any other person appearing to be interested in shares held by that member representing 0.25 per cent. or more of the class of shares concerned fails to supply to the Company any information 115 required by any section 793 notice (see “voting” above), the Directors may by notice to that member direct that any dividend (or any part of it) or other amount payable on those shares (except on a winding up of the Company) will be retained by the Company. The Company will not be obliged to pay interest on that dividend and the member concerned will have no right to receive any additional shares in the Company in lieu of any dividends. 6.3.4 On a winding up of the Company, the Company’s assets available for distribution must be divided among the members in proportion to the nominal amounts of capital paid up or credited as paid up on the shares held by them, subject to the terms of issue of or rights attaching to any shares. 6.4 Unclaimed dividends Any dividends unclaimed may be used for the benefit of the Company until claimed. Any dividend which is still unclaimed twelve years after having become due for payment will be forfeited and revert to the Group. 6.5 Untraced shareholders The Company may sell any shares in the Company of a member or person entitled to shares by transmission who is untraceable if, during the period of twelve years prior to the date of the publication in both a national newspaper and a newspaper circulating in the area where the member’s or person’s last known address is located of its intention to sell: 6.5.1 no cheque, warrant or money order addressed to the member or the person entitled by transmission has been cashed; 6.5.2 no cash dividend has been satisfied by a transfer of funds; 6.5.3 the Company has paid at least three cash dividends (whether interim or final) and no such dividend has been claimed; 6.5.4 the shares have been in issue during the 12 year period and the Company has received no communication in respect of the shares from the holder or person entitled by transmission during either the 12 year period or period of 3 months following the publication of the later of the two advertisements. 6.6 Redemption Subject to the provisions of the Act, the Company may issue shares which are to be redeemed or are liable to be redeemed at the option of the Company or the member, and the Board may decide the terms, conditions and manner of redemption of any such shares. 6.7 Variation of class rights If at any time the capital of the Company is divided into different classes of shares, all or any of the rights attached to any class of share may (unless the rights attached to the shares provide otherwise) be varied or abrogated with the consent in writing of the holders of not less than three-quarters in nominal value of the issued shares of that class or with the sanction of a resolution passed at a separate general meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. 6.8 Alteration of share capital 6.8.1 There are no conditions imposed by the Company’s articles of association regarding changes in the Company’s capital which are more stringent than required by the laws of England and Wales. Accordingly, subject to complying with the Act (including any requirement to pass a shareholder resolution or resolutions), the Company may alter its share capital in the manner allowed for under the Act, including by sub-dividing or consolidating and sub-dividing its share capital, redenominating or reducing its share capital and purchasing its own shares.The Company’s articles contain provisions allowing the Board to deal with fractions arising on consolidation and division or a sub-division of shares as it thinks fit. 6.8.2 Statutory rights of pre-emption apply under the Act to the issue of any new shares for cash consideration so that shares must first be offered to members pro rata to their existing 116 shares except to the extent the members have disapplied such pre-emption rights by resolution at general meeting. 6.9 Transfer of shares All transfers of certificated shares must be effected by instrument in writing, in any usual or other form approved by the Directors and must be executed by or on behalf of the transferor and, if the share is partly paid, by the transferee. Uncertificated shares may be transferred in accordance with the Uncertificated Securities Regulations 2001 (SI 2001 No. 3755) and the facilities and requirements of the relevant system (as defined under those regulations). The Directors may, in their absolute discretion, decline to register any transfer of a share if: 6.9.1 the share is not fully paid; 6.9.2 there is a lien on the share; 6.9.3 it is in respect of more than one class of share; 6.9.4 it is to more than four joint holders; 6.9.5 it is not duly stamped (if so required by law); or 6.9.6 it has not been delivered for registration or is not supported by evidence of transfer of title, provided in each case that the refusal to register could not prevent the shares of the same class from continuing to be admitted to trading. 6.10 Calls on shares 6.10.1 The Board may make calls on the members (and persons entitled to shares by transmission) in respect of any amounts unpaid on their shares (whether in respect of nominal amount or premium). Each member must (subject to being given at least fourteen clear days’ notice specifying when and where payment is to be made) pay to the Company as required by the notice the amount called on his shares. 6.10.2 A call may be postponed or revoked in whole or in part as the Board decides. A person on whom a call is made will remain liable for calls made on him notwithstanding the subsequent transfer of the shares in respect of which the call was made. The joint holders of a share are jointly and severally liable to pay all calls in respect of it. 6.11 Forfeiture If a call remains unpaid after it has become due and payable, the Board may give to the person from whom it is due not less than fourteen clear days’ notice requiring payment of the amount unpaid together with any interest which may have accrued. The notice must state a place at which payment is to be made and that if the notice is not complied with, the shares on which the call was made will be liable to be forfeited. Any share forfeited will become the property of the Company. 6.12 Lien The Company has a first and paramount lien on each issued share which is a partly paid share for all amounts payable in respect of such share. The lien takes priority over any third party’s interest in the share and extends to all dividends or other moneys payable by the Company in respect the share. The Board may at any time declare any share exempt in whole or in part, from the provisions of the articles on liens. 6.13 Disclosure of interest in shares There are no provisions in the Articles by which persons acquiring, holding or disposing of a certain percentage of the Company’s shares are required to make disclosure of their ownership percentage. However, as set out in paragraph 3.11, the provisions of Chapter 5 of the Disclosure and Transparency Rules made by the FCA under Part VI of FSMA apply. 6.14 Change of control There are no provisions in the articles which would have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change of control of the Company. 117 6.15 Directors 6.15.1 Remuneration of Directors Each of the Directors is entitled to receive, by way of ordinary remuneration for his services in each year, such sum as the Board may decide. The Directors are also entitled to be repaid all travelling, hotel and other expenses properly incurred by them in connection with the performance of their duties as Directors. The Board may also grant additional special remuneration to any Director who, being called upon, performs any special duties outside his ordinary duties as a Director. 6.15.2 Appointment of Directors Directors may be appointed by an ordinary resolution of the Company in general meeting or by the Board. 6.15.3 Number of Directors and votes Unless and until otherwise determined by the Company by ordinary resolution, the number of Directors (other than alternate Directors) may not be less than two in number. The quorum necessary for the transaction of business of the Board may be fixed by the Board at two or more and otherwise is two. Questions arising at a meeting of directors must be decided by a majority of votes. In the case of equality of votes, the chairman has a second or casting vote. 6.15.4 Directors’ permitted interests A Director is permitted to enter into contracts or arrangements with the Group and persons in which the Group is otherwise interested; hold any office or place of profit (except that of auditor) with and be a director, officer or employee of (or party to any contract or arrangement with) any body corporate promoted by the Group or in which the Group is otherwise interested. The Director will not be accountable to the Company or the members for any remuneration, profit or other benefit he derives from such interest and no such transaction is be liable to be avoided. However, a Director must declare the nature and extent of any direct or indirect interest in a transaction or arrangement with the Group under sections 177 and 182 of the Act. 6.15.5 Directors’ conflicts of interest Each Director must also declare any situation in which he has or can have a direct (or indirect) interest which conflicts (or may conflict) with the interests of the Group which, if not authorised or ratified would amount to a breach of section 175 of the Act (a conflict). Authorisation of a Directors’ conflict may be given by the Board, not counting the Director concerned or any other Director interested in that matter in the quorum and not counting their vote(s). The authorisation may be subject to such terms and for such duration or impose such limits or conditions as the authorisation specifies and may be terminated or varied by the Board at any time. Unless otherwise provided by the authorisation, the Director is authorised (without breaching his duties to the Company) not to disclose any information to the Company which he has obtained otherwise than as a Director of the Company; and to absent himself from Board meetings and discussions relating to the conflict. The Director will not be accountable to the Company or the members for any remuneration, profit or other benefit he derives from an interest so authorised and no such transaction is liable to be avoided on the ground of the Director having an interest authorised by the Board. 6.15.6 Voting and counting to quorum on interested matters A Director may not vote on or be counted to the quorum in relation to any contract or arrangement or any other proposal in which he has an interest (otherwise than by virtue of his interest in shares or debentures or other securities of, or otherwise in or through, the Company) other than a resolution: (a) relating to a matter which cannot reasonably be regarded as likely to give rise to a conflict of interest; 118 (b) relating to the giving of any security or indemnity to him in respect of money lent or obligations incurred by him at the request of or for the benefit of any member of the Group; (c) relating to the giving of any security or indemnity in respect of a debt or obligation of any member of the Group for which he himself has assumed responsibility in whole or in part under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security; (d) relating to the giving to him of any indemnity where all the other Directors are being offered indemnities on substantially the same terms; (e) relating to the funding by the Company of his expenditure on defending proceedings (or to enable him to avoid incurring such expenditure) where all the other Directors are being offered substantially the same arrangements; (f) relating to an offer of securities by any member of the Group in which he is or may be entitled to participate as a holder of securities or in the underwriting or subunderwriting of which he is to participate; (g) relating to any proposal concerning any other body corporate in which he is interested directly or indirectly and whether as an officer, shareholder, employee, creditor or otherwise, provided that he is not the holder of a beneficial interest in one per cent. or more of any class of equity share capital or of the voting rights in such body corporate; (h) relating to an arrangement for the benefit of employees of any member of the Group which does not award him any privilege or benefit not generally awarded to employees to whom the arrangement relates; (i) relating to any proposal concerning the adoption, modification or operation of a superannuation fund or retirement, death or disability benefit scheme which is approved by or subject to the approval of the HM Revenue & Customs or relating to any arrangement for the benefit of employees generally which does not accord to him as a Director any privilege or advantage not generally accorded; (j) relating to any proposal concerning the purchase and/or maintenance of an insurance policy under which a Director may benefit; or (k) relating to a matter authorised pursuant to paragraph 6.15.5 of this Part 4. 6.15.7 Qualification shares There is no requirement for Directors to hold qualification shares. 6.15.8 Retirement by rotation At each annual general meeting: any Director appointed by the Board since the last annual general meeting; any Director who held office at the preceding two annual general meetings and who did not retire by rotation at either of them; and any Director who agrees to do so must retire by rotation. A Director who retires, if willing to act, may be reappointed. 6.15.9 Indemnity of Directors Subject to the provisions of the Act, every director or other officer of the Company may be indemnified out of the assets of the Company against any liability incurred by that Director in connection with: any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust in relation to the Company or its subsidiaries; the activities of the Company or a subsidiary of the Company in its capacity as a trustee of an occupational pension scheme; or any other liability incurred by the Director as an officer of the Company or any of its subsidiaries. The Directors of the Company may purchase and maintain insurance at the expense of the Company for the benefit of any Director or former director of the Company or any of its subsidiaries against any loss or liability which has been or may be incurred in connection with that Director’s duties or powers in relation to the Company, any subsidiary of the Company or any pension fund or employees’ share scheme of the Company or subsidiary of the Company. 119 6.16 General meetings 6.16.1 The Board must convene and the Company must hold annual general meetings in accordance with the Act. The Board may convene other general meetings when it decides to do so and on request by the members under section 303 of the Act. 6.16.2 An annual general meeting must be convened by at least 21 clear days’ notice. All other general meetings must be convened by at least 14 clear days’ notice. 6.16.3 The notice must comply with legislation applicable to the Company, including the Act relating to the content of notice of meetings including by specifying the place, day and time of the meeting together with the general nature of the business to be transacted at the meeting, and a statement of the members’ right to appoint a proxy. The notice may also specify the time by which a person must be entered on the Register of Members in order for such a person to have the right to attend and vote at the meeting. 6.17 Proceedings at general meetings 6.17.1 No business may be transacted at a general meeting other than the appointment of a chairman of the meeting, unless at least two people entitled to attend and vote are present. 6.17.2 At a general meeting a resolution put to the vote of the meeting must be decided on a show of hands, unless before, or upon the declaration of the result of, the show of hands a poll is demanded by either: (a) the chairman of the meeting; (b) at least three members present in person or by proxy having the rights to vote at the meeting; (c) a member or members present in person or by proxy representing not less than 10 per cent. of the total voting rights of all the members present in person or by proxy and having the right to vote on the resolution; or (d) one or more members present in person or by proxy holding shares conferring a right to vote on the resolution on which an aggregate sum has been paid up equal to not less than 10 per cent. of the total sum paid up on all the shares conferring that right. 6.17.3 Unless a poll is demanded, a declaration by the chairman of the meeting that a resolution has been carried, or carried unanimously or by a particular majority, or lost, or not carried by a particular majority, and an entry to that effect in the book containing minutes of the proceedings of general meetings of the Company, is conclusive evidence of the fact without proof of the number or proportion of the votes recorded in favour of or against such resolution. 6.18 Powers of borrowing and mortgaging The Directors may exercise all the powers of the Company to borrow money, and to mortgage or charge the whole or any part of its undertaking, property and assets and uncalled capital, and to issue debentures and other securities. 6.19 Reserves The Board may set aside out of the profits of the Company and carry to reserve such sums as it decides. Such sums standing to reserve may be applied, at the Board’s discretion, for any purpose to which the profits of the Company may properly be applied and, pending such application, may either be employed in the business of the Company or be invested in such investments as the Board decides. 6.20 Mandatory Offers (Code Provisions) 6.20.1 The provisions summarised below apply unless the Code applies to the Company. 6.20.2 Except with the consent of an ordinary resolution of independent Shareholders (i.e. excluding a potential offeror and persons acting in concert with it) on a poll, and subject to 120 exemptions for inadvertent mistake and other matters where Rule 9 of the Code would not apply, when: (a) any Shareholder (or person acting in concert with such Shareholder) acquires, whether in a single transaction or by a series of transactions over a period of time, an interest in shares in the Company which (taken together with shares in which such Shareholder or persons acting in concert with such Shareholder are interested) carry 30 per cent. or more of the voting rights of the Company; or (b) shares in the Company which in aggregate carry not less than 30 per cent. of the voting rights of the Company but does not hold shares carrying more than 50 per cent. of such voting rights and such Shareholder, or any person acting in concert with such Shareholder, acquires an interest in any other shares which increases the percentage of shares carrying voting rights in which he is interested, such Shareholder shall extend an offer to the holders of all the issued (and to be issued) shares in the Company except in certain circumstances where such acquisition has been expressly authorised under the Lock-in and Orderly Market Agreement. 6.20.3 Such offer must be in cash at not less than the highest price paid by the offeror (or any person acting in concert with it) for any interest in shares in the Company during the previous 12 months, and must be conditional only upon the offeror having received acceptances in respect of shares which, together with shares acquired or agreed to be acquired before or during the offer, will result in the offeror and any person acting in concert with it holding shares carrying more than 50 per cent. of the voting rights of the Company. The offer must be made on terms that would be required by the then current Code, save to the extent that the board of directors otherwise determines. Any matter which under the Code would fall to be determined by the Takeover Panel shall be determined by the board of directors in its absolute discretion or by such person appointed by the board to make such determination. 6.20.4 Except with the consent of a majority of independent Shareholders (i.e. excluding an offeror and persons acting in concert with it) on a poll, Shareholders shall comply with the requirements of the Code (as if the Code applied to the Group) in relation to any dealings in any shares in the Company and in relation to their dealings with the Company in relation to all matters. 6.20.5 At all times when the Company would be in an “offer period” for the purposes of the Code each Shareholder shall comply with the disclosure obligations set out in Rule 8 of the Code as if the Code applied to the Company. 6.20.6 If any Shareholder defaults in making a mandatory offer pursuant to the Articles, or is otherwise in default of the obligations in the Articles relating to takeovers, then the directors may, inter alia, by a direction notice to such Shareholder (and any other Shareholder acting in concert with such Shareholder) direct that: (a) in respect of the shares held by those Shareholders, the Shareholders shall not be entitled to vote at a general meeting either personally or by proxy or to exercise any other right conferred by membership in relation to meetings of the Company; (b) no payment shall be made of any sums due from the Company on such shares in respect of dividend; and/or (c) the shares held by such Shareholder are to be sold. Any decision to be made, or discretion to be exercised, by the directors shall be made or exercised excluding any director who is (or may be) obliged to make an offer pursuant to the Articles or who is acting in concert with any person who is (or may be) obliged to make such an offer. 7. 7.1 DIRECTORS’ AND OTHER INTERESTS As at the date of this document and as expected to be immediately following the Placing and Admission, the holdings of the Directors and any other applicable employee of the Company (as defined in the AIM Rules), and their families in the share capital of the Company (i) which would have 121 been required to be notified by the Company pursuant to Rule 17 of the AIM Rules; or (ii) which are holdings of a person connected (within the meaning of section 252 of the Act) with a Director which would, if the connected person were a Director, be required to be disclosed under (i) above and the existence of which is known to or could with reasonable diligence be ascertained by the Directors are as follows: Name % of Number of the issued Ordinary Ordinary Shares Share Capital prior to prior to the Placing the Placing TRGI 32,250,055 100% Number of Ordinary Shares upon Admission % of issued Share Capital upon Admission Options 29,653,932 75% Nil * Muhammad Chishti and Mohammedulla Khaishgi are directors of TRGI. 7.2 As at the date of this document, the following options have been granted to Directors or otherwise over Existing Shares under the TRGI Stock Plan: Name Stephen Kezirian Karl Gabel Tim Kelly Per cent. of enlarged share capital immediately Number of following share options Admission Vesting schedule Exercise period (from) Exercise Price 1,495,443 3.8 591,946 options vest on 30 June 2013; 31,155 stock options vesting monthly from 30 November 2015 30 June 2013 $1.55 442,307 1.1 221,154 options vest on 30 June 2013; 12,286 stock options vesting monthly from 31 July 2013 30 June 2013 $1.55 49,848 0.1 12,462 options vest on 31 December 2013; 1,039 stock options vesting monthly from 31 December 2016 31 December 2013 $1.55 122 7.3 Save as disclosed in paragraph 7.1 and paragraph 7.2 above, the Group is not aware of any holding (within the meaning of the AIM Rules) in the Group’s ordinary share capital which amounts or would, immediately following the Placing and Admission, amount to 3 per cent. or more of the Group’s issued ordinary share capital other than the following: Name % of Number of the issued Ordinary Ordinary Shares Share Capital prior to prior to the Placing the Placing Standard Life Investments Limited Fidelity Investments International Miton Capital Partners Limited 0 0 0 0 0 0 Number of % of Ordinary issued Shares Share Capital upon upon Admission Admission 2,530,119 2,125,300 1,870,088 6.40 5.37 4.73 The voting rights of the Shareholders set out in paragraphs 7.1 and 7.2 do not differ from the voting rights held by other Shareholders. 7.4 There are no outstanding loans granted or guarantees provided by the Group to or for the benefit of any of the Directors, nor are there any outstanding loans or guarantees provided by the Directors to or for the benefit of the Group. 7.5 Save as disclosed in this paragraph 7, no Director has any interest, whether direct or indirect, in any transaction which is or was unusual in its nature or conditions or significant to the business of the Group taken as a whole and which was effected by the Group during the current or immediately preceding financial year, or during any earlier financial year and which remains in any respect outstanding or unperformed. 7.6 Save as otherwise disclosed in this document, none of the directors nor any member of their respective families nor any person connected with the Directors (within the meaning of section 252 of the Act) has any holding, whether beneficial or otherwise, in the share capital of the Group. 7.7 None of the Directors nor any member of a Director’s family is dealing in any related financial product (as defined in the AIM Rules) whose value in whole or in part is determined directly or indirectly by reference to the price of the ordinary shares, including a contract for differences or a fixed odds bet. 8. 8.1 DIRECTORS’ SERVICE AGREEMENTS/LETTERS OF APPOINTMENT The executive directors have entered into the following service/employment agreements with IBEX Inc.: 8.1.1 Stephen Kezirian An employment agreement with Mr Kezirian effective as of 1 December 2011, pursuant to which Mr Kezirian will continue to be employed as Chief Executive Officer. Pursuant to the agreement, Mr Kezirian’s annual salary will be $240,000. In addition he may receive a discretionary cash or equity bonus that is currently targeted to be 40 per cent. of his gross base salary. In addition, Mr Kezirian will be eligible to participate in any benefit plan offered by IBEX Inc. and will be entitled to 15 days paid leave per year. Mr Kezirian may terminate his employment for any reason with 3 months’ prior notice. IBEX Inc. may waive all or part of such notice period. IBEX Inc. may terminate Mr Kezirian’s employment at any time by providing 1 months’ notice. During his employment and for a 24 month period thereafter, Mr Kezirian will be subject to non-solicitation of employees, non-solicitation of customers and, for a 12 month period thereafter, non-competition covenants. 8.1.2 Karl Gabel An employment agreement with Mr Gabel commencing on 21 January 2008 (as amended), pursuant to which Mr Gabel will be employed as Chief Financial Officer and Executive Vice President. Pursuant to the agreement, Mr Gabel’s annual salary will be $250,000. In addition he may receive a discretionary cash bonus that is currently targeted to be 25 per cent. of his 123 gross base salary. In addition, Mr Gabel will be eligible to participate in any benefit plan offered by IBEX Inc. and will be entitled to 20 days paid leave per year. Mr Gabel may terminate his employment for any reason on 3 months’ notice. IBEX Inc. may terminate Mr Gabel’s employment at any time by providing one months’ notice. During his employment and for a 12 month period thereafter, Mr Gabel will be subject to non-solicitation of employees, nonsolicitation of customers and non-competition covenants. 8.2 Stephen Kezirian and Karl Gabel have entered into the following agreements with the Company to serve as directors of the Company: 8.2.1 Stephen Kezirian A letter of agreement with Mr Kezirian pursuant to which Mr Kezirian is invited to become a director of the Company with effect from the date of his formal appointment to the Board, being 4 June 2013. Pursuant to the agreement, Mr Kezirian’s annual salary will be $1 per annum. In addition he will be reimbursed for any reasonable expenses incurred in connection with his services as a director of the Company in accordance with the Company’s established policies and the Articles. Mr Kezirian may terminate his service as director of the Company for any reason with 3 month’s prior written notice. The Company may terminate his service as a director of the Company for any reason with one prior written month’s notice. The Company may terminate Mr Kezirian’s service as director upon the earlier of: (i) the conclusion of the full terms of his directorship with the Company in the event that he is not re-elected as a director of the Company at the Company’s annual general meeting; (ii) voluntary termination of his directorship by the Company in accordance with the Articles by any means or for any reason upon providing written notice; (iii) the date of termination of his employment with IBEX Inc.; or (iv) the Company’s termination of his directorship immediately by written notice in the event of a material breach of his fiduciary duties to the Company or his material breach of any provision of his letter agreement. During his directorship and for the maximum period permitted by law, Mr Kezirian will be subject to non-disclosure and non-disparagement obligations. 8.2.2 Karl Gabel A letter of agreement with Mr Gabel pursuant to which Mr Gabel is invited to become a director of the Company with effect from the date of his formal appointment to the Board, being 4 June 2013. Pursuant to the agreement, Mr Gabel’s annual salary will be $1 per annum. In addition he will be reimbursed for any reasonable expenses incurred in connection with his services as a director of the Company in accordance with the Company’s established policies and the Articles. Mr Gabel may terminate his service as director of the Company for any reason with 3 month’s prior written notice. The Company may terminate his service as a director of the Company for any reason with one month’s prior written notice. The Company may terminate Mr Gabel’s service as director upon the earlier of: (i) the conclusion of the full terms of his directorship with the Company in the event that he is not re-elected as a director of the Company at the Company’s annual general meeting; (ii) voluntary termination of his directorship by the Company in accordance with the Articles of the Company by any means or for any reason upon providing written notice; (iii) the date of termination of his employment with IBEX Inc.; or (iv) the Company’s termination of his directorship immediately by written notice in the event of a material breach of his fiduciary duties to the Company or his material breach of any provision of the letter agreement. During his directorship and for the maximum period permitted by law, Mr Gabel will be subject to non-disclosure and non-disparagement obligations. 8.3 Each of the non-executive directors has entered into a letter of appointment with the Company under the terms of which they agree to act as a non-executive director of the Company for a fee of $60,000 per annum, save for Zia Chishti and Mohammedulla Khaishgi, who shall be paid $1. Each non-executive director may terminate his service as director of the Company with 3 months’ prior written notice. The Company may terminate a non-executive director’s employment at any time by providing one months notice. 8.4 Save as disclosed in sub-paragraphs 8.1 to 8.3 above, there are no service contracts, existing or proposed, between any Director and the Group. 124 8.5 Details of the commencement and expiration of the term of office of each Director and members of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies of the Group who were in office during the Group’s last financial year are set out below: Name Muhammad Ziaullah Khan Chishti Stephen Kezirian Karl Gabel Mohammedulla Khaishgi Tim Kelly John Leone Jimmy Holland Commencement of Period of Office 26 March 2013 Date of expiration of term of Office Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 5 June 2013 5 June 2013 3 June 2013 5 June 2013 5 June 2013 16 May 2013 Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 Annual General Meeting to be held in 2014 Indefinite 8.6 There are no service contracts in place between the Group or any subsidiary and any member of the administrative/management or supervisory bodies which provides for benefits on termination of employment. 9. 9.1 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON THE BOARD In addition to directorships of the Group the Directors hold or have held the following directorships or have been partners in the following partnerships within the five years prior to the date of this document: Director (insert any previous names) Muhammad Ziaullah Khan Chishti Stephen Kezirian Age 41 39 Current Directorships and Partnerships The Resource Group International Limited Digital Globe Services, Ltd The Resource Group Pakistan Limited SATMAP International Holdings Limited SATMAP, Incorporated SATMAP Worldwide Marketing Limited IBEX Global Solutions Limited IBEX Global Solutions Philippines Kezirian Ventures LLC Multiband Corporation TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc. TRG Marketing Solutions Ltd IBEX Global Senegal Ltd Proginet Corporation TRG Philippines, Inc. TRG Global Solutions (Philippines) Inc. GL Beyond Income Fund 125 Past Directorships and Partnerships OrthoClear Incorporated Align Technology, Inc. Karl Gabel Mohammedulla Khaishgi 49 45 None The Resource Group International Limited IBEX Inc. TRG Holdings LLC Alert Communications Inc. BPO Solutions Inc. iSky Inc SATMAP Incorporated SATMAP International Holdings Limited TRG Marketing Services Inc. TRG Philippines None Azgard Nine Lever Arch (UK) plc Tim Kelly 54 Zubie Inc Network Solutions Greenlight Connected Solutions John Leone 40 PineBridge Investment Partners LLC Nabbe Holdings GP, Ltd The Resource Group International Limited TRG Pakistan Limited Companhia Providencia Industria e Comercia S.A. PineBridge Latin America II GP, LP PineBridge GEM II GP, LP PineBridge GEM Viaduct GP, LP PineBridge Kamchia GP, LP PineBridge New Europe II GP, LP PineBridge RCP GP, LP 9.2 The Securities and Exchange Commission of Pakistan (“SECP”) brought proceedings against The Resource Group Pakistan Limited and members of its management, including Zia Chishti, in relation to default in complying with company regulations, failure to hold a company AGM in 2010 and the associated failure to submit accounts at the AGM. As part of the proceedings, various individuals were fined by the SECP, including a Rs. 250,000 (approximately £1,600) fine for Zia Chishti for two separate violations of section 158(1) of the Companies Ordinance and Rule 7(1) of the Non Finance Banking Company rules. 9.3 Mohammedulla Khaishgi was a director of Lever Arch (UK) plc from April 2006 to October 2009. The company was placed into administration in November 2009 and subsequently dissolved in November 2010. At the time of the administration the company’s assets were approximately £40,000. 9.4 Save as disclosed above none of the directors has: 9.4.1 any unspent convictions in relation to indictable offences; 9.4.2 had any bankruptcy order made against him or entered into any voluntary arrangements; 9.4.3 been a director of a company which has been placed in receivership, compulsory liquidation, creditors’ voluntary liquidation, administration, been subject to a voluntary arrangement or any composition or arrangement with its creditors generally or any class of its creditors whilst he was a director of that company or within the 12 months after he ceased to be a director of that company; 126 9.4.4 been a partner in any partnership which has been placed in compulsory liquidation, administration or been the subject of a partnership voluntary arrangement whilst he was a partner in that partnership or within the 12 months after he ceased to be a partner in that partnership; 9.4.5 been the owner of any assets or a partner in any partnership which has been placed in receivership whilst he was a partner in that partnership or within the 12 months after he ceased to be a partner in that partnership; 9.4.6 been publicly criticised by any statutory or regulatory authority (including recognised professional bodies); or 9.4.7 been disqualified by a court from acting as a director of any company or from acting in the management or conduct of the affairs of a Company. 10. EMPLOYEES 10.1 As at 31 December 2012, the Group had 6,900 employees. As at the date of this document, the Group has 8,100 employees. 11. CORPORATE STRUCTURE AND PRE-ADMISSION REORGANISATION 11.1 The structure of the Group as at the date of Admission is set out below: Note: The structure chart above does not, in all cases, reflect the actual corporate names of the relevant entities. They have been named by their country of incorporation and operation for ease of reference. * Minority holdings in these companies are held by third parties. Please see paragraph 1.7 of Part 4 for more information. 11.2 Prior to Admission, the Group was reorganised as detailed in this paragraph 11 (“Reorganisation”). Prior to the Reorganisation: 11.2.1 TRG Holdings LLC held the entire issued share capital in IBEX Inc.; 11.2.2 TRGI held the entire issued share capital of: (a) TRG Philippines Inc.; (b) The Resource Group Senegal SA; (c) TRG Marketing Solutions Limited; and 127 (d) Virtual World (Private) Limited; and 11.2.3 TRG (Private) Limited held the entire issued share capital in IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd. 11.3 Pursuant to the Reorganisation (among other things): 11.3.1 the ownership of TRG Philippines Inc. has been transferred from TRGI to the Group by way of (i) a tax-free distribution of TRG Philippines Inc.’s shares from TRG Holdings LLC to TRGI and (ii) a contribution of the shares in TRG Philippines Inc. by TRGI to the Group; 11.3.2 the ownership of TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and Virtual World (Private) Limited has been contributed by TRGI to the Group; 11.3.3 the ownership of TRG Philippines Inc. and The Resource Group Senegal SA has been contributed by TRGI to the Group; 11.3.4 the ownership of IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd has been transferred to the Group by TRG (Private) Limited; 11.3.5 the Company incorporated IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l; 11.3.6 the Company acquired the entire issued share capital of Lovercius Consultants Limited; and 11.3.7 IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd purchased certain assets from TRG (Private) Limited. 11.4 A more detailed summary of the Reorganisation is set out below: 11.4.1 On 29 March 2013 IBEX Inc. sold certain of its internally developed intellectual property to TRGI for US$7,500,000 in exchange for a promissory note issued by TRGI in favour of IBEX Inc. (TRGI Promissory Note) pursuant to an intellectual property acquisition agreement dated 29 March 2013 (the IP Sale Agreement); IBEX Inc. assigned the TRGI Promissory Note to TRG Holdings, LLC pursuant to an assignment agreement entered into between (1) IBEX Inc. and (2) TRG Holdings, LLC and accordingly the TRGI Promissory Note balances will be owed from TRGI to TRG Holdings, LLC going forward; and IBEX Inc. entered into an intellectual property licence agreement with TRGI (the TRGI IP Licence), pursuant to which TRGI licences certain intellectual property to IBEX Inc. TRGI IP Licence was later terminated with effect from 8 May 2013. 11.4.2 On 30 March 2013 TRG Marketing Solutions Limited received an application for shares from TRGI, for 1,566,468 ordinary shares in the capital of TRG Marketing Solutions Limited in exchange for the cancellation and release by TRGI of a promissory note dated 30 March 2013 in the sum of US$2,381,046 made by TRG Marketing Solutions Limited in favour of TRGI. TRGI entered into a release agreement with TRG Marketing Solutions Limited pursuant to which TRGI agreed to release and discharge TRG Marketing Solutions Limited of its obligation to pay TRGI the sum of US$2,381,046 under the promissory note dated 30 March 2013. IBEX Inc. entered into a release agreement with (1) TRG Holdings, LLC, (2) TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc, (3) Alert Communications, Inc (Alert), (4) TRG Marketing Solutions Limited, (5) iSky, Inc (TRG iSky) and (6) BPO Solutions, Inc (BPO Solutions) pursuant to which IBEX Inc. agreed to release and discharge each of these entities from their obligations to pay IBEX Inc. the amounts owed to IBEX Inc. as at the date of the release agreement. The Resource Group Senegal SA and TRGI entered into an assignment agreement pursuant to which The Resource Group Senegal SA assigned amounts owed to TRG Holdings, LLC, TRG Marketing Services Inc., TRG (Private) Limited, BPO Solutions, TRGiSky, TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and TRG Philippines Inc. to TRGI in consideration for the issue by The Resource Group Senegal SA of a promissory note in favour of TRGI in the amount of US$674,173. The maturity date stated on the promissory note is 30 March 2014 and the 128 interest rate, which shall accrue from 30 March 2013 on the unpaid principal amount, is 1.95 per cent. per annum (Senegal Promissory Note). The Resource Group Senegal SA and TRGI also entered into a release agreement pursuant to which TRGI agreed to (i) release The Resource Group Senegal SA from the amount owed to it pursuant to the Senegal Promissory Note and (ii) release The Resource Group Senegal SA from its obligation to repay TRGI US$1,213,050 pursuant to certain intercompany transactions in consideration for the allotment and issue by The Resource Group Senegal SA of an additional 87,914 shares in the capital of The Resource Group Senegal SA to TRGI. TRGI and the Company entered into an assignment agreement pursuant to which TRGI transferred its 93,309 shares of 10,000 Francs each in the capital of The Resource Group Senegal SA to the Company for a price of 933,090,000 Francs. 11.4.3 On 31 March 2013 The sole member and management committee of TRG Holdings, LLC jointly consented to the distribution by TRG Holdings, LLC of its stock in IBEX Inc. to TRGI; The board of IBEX Inc. unanimously consented to (i) the cancellation of its entire issued stock, being 1,500 common shares, previously issued to TRG Holdings, LLC and (ii) the issue of 1,500 common shares in the capital of IBEX Inc. as uncertificated shares to TRGI; The board of IBEX Inc. unanimously consented to (i) the cancellation of its entire issued stock, being 1,500 common shares, previously issued to TRGI and (ii) the issue of 1,500 common shares in the capital of IBEX Inc. as uncertificated shares to the Company; The Company received an application for shares from TRGI, for 1,566,470 ordinary shares of £1.00 each in the capital of the Company in exchange for the contribution by TRGI of 1,566,470 shares of £1.00 each in the capital of TRG Marketing Solutions Limited, being the entire issued share capital of TRG Marketing Solutions Limited to the Company; A record of decisions of the sole director of the Company indicates that the Company also received an application for shares from TRGI, for 30,683,484 Ordinary Shares in exchange for the contribution by TRGI of the following assets to the Company: (a) 93,309 shares of 1,000 Francs each in the capital of The Resource Group Senegal SA, which, save for five shares held by Famara Ibrahima Sagna (please refer to the footnote in paragraph 1.7 of this Part 4), comprise the entire issued share capital of The Resource Group Senegal SA; (b) 409,995 common stock in TRG Philippines Inc. of PP.100 each, together with the beneficial ownership of five shares in the capital of TRG Philippines Inc. held on trust for TRGI by its directors (please refer to the footnote in paragraph 1.7 of this Part 4), which together comprise the entire issued share capital of TRG Philippines Inc.; (c) 3,257,680 shares of Rs.10 each in the capital of Virtual World Private Limited, together with the beneficial ownership of two shares in Virtual World Private Limited held on trust for TRGI by the directors of Virtual World Private Limited (please refer to the footnote in paragraph 1.7 of this Part 4), which together comprise the entire issued share capital of Virtual World Private Limited; (d) 1,500 shares of US$0.0001 each in the capital of IBEX Inc. which comprise the entire issued share capital of IBEX Inc.; (e) €17,000 to be applied towards the Company’s costs of incorporating a Luxembourg subsidiary which has a paid up capital of US$21,788; (f) US$1,000,000 in prepaid SATMAP services pursuant to a first draft amendment to the commercial schedule dated 31 March 2013 and a promissory note from TRGI of even date in the sum of US$1,000,000 due in full on 30 June 2017 with an annual interest rate of 1.95 per cent. per annum; and (g) TRGI and Lovercius Consultants Limited entered into an intellectual property licence agreement pursuant to which TRGI licenses certain intellectual property to Lovercius Consultants Limited for consideration of US$1.00. 129 11.4.4 On 1 April 2013 IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd (as transferee) and TRG (Private) Limited (as transferor) entered into an asset purchase agreement pursuant to which TRG Private sold a number of assets to IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd comprising: (a) computer hardware and call centre related equipment; (b) Rs. 13,379,052.62 receivable from Google; (c) Rs. 11,434,642.74 receivable from SquareTrade, together with a promissory note in the sum of Rs.6,321,400.85 issued by TRG (Private) Limited in favour of IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd with a maturity date of 31 December 2017 and an interest rate of 12.5 per cent. per annum (TRG Promissory Note). In consideration for the transfer of the assets to IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd, it acquired the following obligations of TRG (Private) Limited: (d) withholding tax salaries (Rs. 2,058,298); (e) provident fund payable (Rs. 2,010,517); (f) Employees Old-age Benefits Institution payable (Rs. 230,880); (g) salaries, wages and other benefits payable (Rs. 32,446,588); (h) AYK (Pvt) Ltd (Rs. 1,198,500); and (i) Mega Plus Pakistan (Rs. 7,784,012). TRG (Private) Limited exercised its right under the TRG Promissory Note to offset the amount of Rs. 6,321,40085 owed by Virtual World (Private) Limited to TRG (Private) Limited against the sum owed by TRG (Private) Limited to IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd pursuant to the TRG Promissory Note. 11.4.5 On 8 May 2013 IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l and TRGI entered into an intellectual property acquisition agreement pursuant to which IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l purchased certain intellectual property from TRGI for consideration of US$1.00. IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l and IBEX Inc. entered into an intellectual property licence agreement pursuant to which IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l licenses certain intellectual property to IBEX Inc. 11.4.6 On 28 May 2013 The board of IBEX Inc. unanimously consented to (i) the termination of the intellectual property license agreement entered into between (1) IBEX Inc. and (2) TRGI on 29 March 2013 and (ii) the entry by IBEX Inc. into intellectual property licence agreements with each of IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l and Lovercius Consultants Limited dated 8 May 2013. 12. MATERIAL CONTRACTS In addition to the Reorganisation documents detailed in paragraph 11 above and the related party transactions detailed in paragraph 14 below, the following contracts, not being contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business, have been entered into by the Company or a member of the Group within the two years immediately preceding the date of this document and are, or may be, material: 12.1 A Placing Agreement dated 24 June 2013 between (1) the Company, (2) the Directors (3) TRGI (4) Liberum and (5) Cenkos pursuant to which conditional upon, inter alia, Admission taking place on or before 8.00 a.m. on 28 June 2013 (or such later time and or date as the Company, Liberum and Cenkos may agree being not later than 6.00 p.m. on 31 July 2013), Liberum and Cenkos have agreed to use reasonable endeavours, as agents for the Company, to procure subscribers for the New Ordinary Shares proposed to be issued by the Company at the Placing Price and, as agent for TRGI, to procure purchasers for the Sale Shares proposed to be sold by TRGI at the Placing Price. 130 The Placing Agreement contains warranties from the Company, the Directors and TRGI and an indemnity from the Company in favour of Liberum and Cenkos together with provisions which enable Liberum and Cenkos to terminate the Placing Agreement in certain circumstances prior to Admission including circumstances where any warranties are found to be untrue or inaccurate in any material respect. The liability of the Directors for breach of warranty is limited. Under the Placing Agreement the Company has agreed to pay Liberum and Cenkos a corporate finance advisory fee and a maximum commission of 5 per cent. of the aggregate value of the New Ordinary Shares at the Placing Price. TRGI will pay each of Liberum and Cenkos commission of 5 per cent. of the aggregate value of the Sale Shares at the Placing Price. The Company is responsible for the costs, charges and expenses properly and reasonably incurred by, Liberum and Cenkos in connection with or incidental to the Placing and Admission, including (but not limited to) the reasonable fees and expenses of Liberum and Cenkos’s legal advisers. 12.2 A broker agreement dated 19 June 2013 between (1) the Company and (2) Cenkos pursuant to which Cenkos has agreed to act as joint-broker to the Company following Admission, for an annual fee of £40,000 plus VAT and disbursements. 12.3 Lock-in and Orderly Market Agreements dated 24 June 2013 between (1) Liberum, (2) Cenkos (3) the Company and (4) each of TRGI and the Directors pursuant to which, conditional on Admission: 12.3.1 each of the Directors have undertaken that they will not dispose of Ordinary Shares held by them for a period of one year from the date of Admission; and 12.3.2 TRGI has undertaken that it will not dispose of Ordinary Shares held by them for a period of six months from the date of Admission, save with the consent of Liberum and Cenkos or in certain limited circumstances and then for a further one year in case of the Directors and 18 months in case of TRGI will only dispose of Ordinary Shares held by them through the Company’s broker from time to time. 12.4 A Nominated Adviser and Joint Broker Engagement Letter dated 5 April 2012 between (1) the Group and (2) Liberum pursuant to which the Company has appointed Liberum to act as Nominated Adviser and Joint Broker to the Company for the purposes of the AIM Rules. The Company has agreed to pay Liberum a fee of £50,000 per annum for annum for its services as Nominated Adviser and Joint Broker as well as any out of pocket expenses reasonably incurred by Liberum in connection with the performance of its services under that engagement letter. The engagement letter contains certain undertakings and indemnities given by the Company in respect of, inter alia, compliance with all applicable laws and regulations. The engagement letter may be terminated with or without cause by either party at any time. 12.5 An Engagement Letter dated 10 April 2012 between (1) the Company and (2) Cenkos pursuant to which the Company has appointed Cenkos to act as Financial Adviser, Joint Broker and Placing Agent to the Company for the purposes of the AIM Rules. The engagement letter contains certain undertakings and indemnities given by the Company in respect of, inter alia, compliance with all applicable laws and regulations. The engagement letter may be terminated by either party on one months’ notice or immediately by Cenkos, for cause. 12.6 A Relationship Agreement dated 24 June 2013 between (1) the Company, (2) Liberum, (3) Cenkos and (4) TRGI, pursuant to which, conditional on Admission, TRGI agrees that so long as it holds more than 30 per cent. of the voting rights attaching to the issued Ordinary Shares: 12.6.1 the management of the Company shall be independent from TRGI’s involvement in day to day governance and that all transactions and relationships between TRGI (and its affiliates) and members of the Group will be at arm’s length and on normal commercial terms; 12.6.2 TRGI shall not do anything that would result in a member of the Group not being able to carry on its business independently of TRGI; 12.6.3 TRGI shall not (and shall use reasonable efforts to procure that no member of its group) shall acquire any further interest in Ordinary Shares where such additional interest would mean that the aggregate of its interest (and those of its affiliates) exceeds 75 per cent. of the issued Ordinary Shares; 131 12.6.4 TRGI shall exercise its voting rights to procure that at all times at least two of the nonexecutive directors of the Company shall be independent of TRGI and its affiliates (and it is agreed that two of the non-executive directors of the Company may be representatives of TRGI); 12.6.5 TRGI shall not (and shall take all reasonable steps to ensure that none of its Affiliates shall), save with the prior written consent of Liberum, exercise its voting rights in favour of any proposed amendment to the Articles which violates the terms of the Relationship Agreement; 12.6.6 save with the prior written consent of Liberum and Cenkos, TRGI shall not exercise its voting rights in respect of any transaction between a member of the Group and TRGI (or a member of its group) or in respect of any resolution required pursuant to the AIM Rules or where the AIM Team of the London Stock Exchange requires that TRGI (or any of its affiliates) abstain from voting; and 12.6.7 TRGI shall procure that any director nominated by it to the Board shall not vote in respect of any matter involving an actual or potential transaction, dispute or conflict between TRGI and the Company. 12.7 A Registrar Agreement dated 21 June 2013 between Capita Registrars Limited and the Company pursuant to which the Company will appoint Capita Registrars Limited to act as the registrar of the Ordinary Shares. The Registrar Agreement will contain an indemnity in terms of which the Company indemnifies the registrar from any liabilities which the registrar may incur in the performance of its duties under the Registrar Agreement, except insofar as such liabilities are incurred as a result of the negligence, wilful default or fraud of the registrar. The Registrar Agreement will be terminable at the instance of either party on three months’ written notice. 12.8 As described in paragraph 11 of this Part 4 of this document, effective as of 31 March 2013, Group undertook the Reorganisation, and as a consequence, IBEX Inc. has entered into an indemnification agreement dated 22 May 2013 with TRG Holdings, LLC and TRGI whereby TRG Holdings, LLC and TRGI (TRG Companies) indemnify IBEX Inc., the Company and IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l from and against: 12.8.1 all national, federal, state or local income, franchise, withholding, sales or estimated taxes, or any other tax of any kind incurred in any jurisdiction together with any interest and penalties thereon (Taxes) incurred in the Reorganisation; and 12.8.2 all Taxes measured by or imposed on net income attributable to (a) the period on or prior to 31 March 2013 that are imposed on any current or former member of the TRG Holdings, LLC’s controlled group, or (b) the period after 31 March 2013 that are imposed on IBEX Inc. as having been a member of the TRG Holdings, LLC’s controlled group. The indemnification agreement grants the TRG Companies the right to conduct and control the defence of any inquiry or other proceeding with respect to any taxes that could result in an indemnification claim against the TRG Companies subject to certain protections for the Company. Under the indemnity agreement, IBEX Inc. agrees to indemnify and hold harmless TRGI and TRG Holdings, LLC and its direct and indirect subsidiaries from and against any and all taxes directly resulting from the breach of certain representations or warranties relating to provision of information for the assessment of tax and from making any tax returns or filings which could result in a claim under the indemnity (without the prior consent of TRGI (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed)). 12.9 As security for TRGI’s obligations under the indemnity agreement described in paragraph 12.8 of this Part 4, TRGI has entered into a negative pledge and lock-in deed dated 24 June 2013 with the Company and IBEX Inc. Under this deed, TRGI has: 12.9.1 covenanted with the Company and IBEX Inc. that it will not create any security over TRGI’s interest in 14,900,000 Ordinary Shares. The negative pledge and lock-in deed contains a mechanism to adjust the number of Ordinary Shares periodically restricted under such deed by reference to the market price of Ordinary Shares with the result that Ordinary Shares with a value of $33,800,000 will remain subject to such restrictions during the existence of such deed 132 (provided that no more than 15,000,000 Ordinary Shares and no less than 10,000,000 Ordinary Shares may be subject to such restrictions); 12.9.2 undertaken, in addition to the lock-in arrangements described in paragraph 12.3 of this Part 4, not to dispose of its interest in such shares prior to 30 June 2017; and 12.9.3 given certain representations, warranties and undertakings in relation to the Reorganisation and certain other tax related matters. The negative pledge and lock-in deed shall terminate on the earliest to occur of: (1) such time as, by operation of law, no action may be brought by the US tax authorities which may give rise to a claim under the indemnity agreement; (2) a final adjudication to the effect that no material claim under the indemnity agreement may be brought; and (3) the termination of the indemnity agreement. 13. DEPENDENCE ON INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY ETC. Save as set out in paragraph 14 of this Part 4, the Group is not dependent on any patents, licences, industrial, commercial or financial contracts or new manufacturing processes which have a material effect on the Group’s business or profitability. 14. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS The Group has entered into the following related party transactions: 14.1 The Group Standard Terms and Conditions dated 31 March 2013, together with first and second amendments to the standard terms and conditions dated 31 March 2013 and 5 April 2013 respectively, have been entered into between the Group and SATMAP, Inc. (SATMAP) pursuant to which SATMAP provides a proprietary software application and hardware system that recognises demographic and psychographic patterns, used to effectively route calls between call centre operatives and prospective customers. SATMAP is a company owned and controlled by TRGI. 14.2 IBEX Inc. 14.2.1 Services Agreement Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between IBEX Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which IBEX Inc. provides TRG Holdings LLC with IT services including the hosting of customer data at IBEX Inc.’s data centres in the United States (Data Services), provision of dedicated and shares telecommunications lines and bandwidth (Telco Services) and the provision of mobile phones and mobile phone service (Mobile Services). The Data Services shall be provided to TRG Holdings LLC at cost plus 5 per cent. and the Telco and Mobile Services shall be provided to TRG at cost. 14.2.2 Third Party Services Agreements A third party services agreement dated 1 April 2013 between IBEX Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which (i) IBEX Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC undertake to pay all amounts due to third party providers providing health, dental and life insurance policies to employees of IBEX Inc., TRG Holdings LLC and its affiliates and insurance policies covering IBEX Inc., TRG Holdings LLC and its affiliates and (ii) TRG Holdings LLC undertakes to indemnify IBEX Inc. for any third party claims or other losses arising out of the provision of services by third parties to IBEX Inc. or its affiliates or arising out of any breach by TRG Holdings LLC of any obligation it owes to IBEX Inc. pursuant to the agreement. An agreement dated 1 April 2013 between IBEX Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which IBEX Inc. undertakes to continue to make the settlement payments to Canon Financial Services for certain printers and/or photocopiers used by TRG Field Solutions, Inc. in the sum of US$5,705 on the 25th of each month up to and including 25 January 2016. TRG Holdings LLC also covenants to reimburse IBEX Inc. for any such settlement payments it makes within 15 days of TRG Holdings LLC receiving notice from IBEX Inc. that it has made a settlement payment. TRG Holdings LLC also undertakes to indemnify IBEX Inc. for any third party claims or other losses arising out of the breach by TRG Holdings LLC of any 133 obligation it owes to IBEX Inc. pursuant to the agreement. 14.2.3 Real Estate A sub-lease agreement between IBEX Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which IBEX Inc. subleases premises in Washington DC from TRG will be entered into prior to Admission. 14.2.4 Intellectual Property An intellectual property acquisition agreement dated 29 March 2013 between IBEX Inc. and TRGI pursuant to which TRGI purchased the following software from IBEX Inc.: Transcription API, TRG Analytics, Client Portal, Data Spy, CMOS, Intake Tool, IVR, Portal DW, Recruitment Management System, Security Module, Service Desk/Trakit, TRG Insight, TRG Whisper, ClickIT, Exit Interview, GP 2013, iSite and TRG Foresight in consideration for the issue by TRGI of a promissory note in the sum of US$7,500,000 in favour of IBEX Inc. 14.2.5 Release Agreements Release agreement dated 30 March 2013 between IBEX Inc., TRG Holdings LLC, TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc., Alert Communications, Inc., TRG Marketing Solutions Limited, TRGiSky, Inc. and BPO Solutions, Inc. pursuant to which IBEX Inc. released each entity from its obligation to pay IBEX Inc. sums owed in consideration for the transfer by each entity of US$1.00 to IBEX Inc. 14.2.6 401(k) Plan The following entities have adopted IBEX Inc.’s 401(k) Plan: TRG Holdings LLC, TRG Insurance Solutions, Inc, Stratasoft, Inc, TRGiSky, Inc., TRG Field Solutions and SATMAP. 14.3 TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc. Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc. and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which TRG Customer Solutions (Canada) Inc. provides TRG Holdings LLC with payroll services in respect of its employees in Canada at cost plus 5 per cent. 14.4 TRG Marketing Solutions Limited 14.4.1 Service Agreement Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and TRG Holdings LLC pursuant to which TRG Marketing Solutions Limited provides TRG Holdings LLC with payroll services relating to the employment of TRG Holdings LLC staff in the UK at cost plus 5 per cent. 14.4.2 Release Agreement Release agreement dated 30 March 2013 between TRG Marketing Solutions Limited and TRGI pursuant to which TRGI releases TRG Marketing Solutions Limited from it is obligations pursuant to the promissory note assigned to TRG Marketing Solutions Limited in the sum of US$2,381,046. 14.5 Virtual World (Private) Limited Unsecured Finance Facility dated 29 August 2011 between Virtual World (Private) Limited and TRG (Private) Limited, a company wholly owned by TRG, pursuant to which TRG (Private) Limited has made a facility of Rs.150,000,000 (approximately £1 million) available to Virtual World (Private) Limited at an interest rate of 17 per cent. per annum, maturing on 1 September 2014. 14.6 IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd IBEX Global Solutions Pvt Ltd has entered into three separate lease agreements dated 27 March 2013 with TRG (Private) Limited as landlord in respect of the following premises: (i) 1 Kanal, 13 Marlas situated at Aitchison Road, off Raiwind Road, Lahore, (ii) 11th floor Southfall 1001, ISE Towers situation at Jinnah Avenue blue area, and (iii) 7th floor, block B, FTC situation at Shahrah-EFaisal. 134 14.7 Lovercius Consultants Limited 14.7.1 Service Agreement Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and TRGiSky, Inc., a company owned by TRGI, pursuant to which IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l provides up to 10 full time equivalent call centre agents and/or management personnel on a monthly basis to TRGiSky, Inc. at cost plus 20 per cent. Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and Alert Communications, Inc. pursuant to which Lovercius Consultants Limited provides up to 10 full time equivalent call centre agents and/or management personnel on a monthly basis to Alert Communications, Inc. at cost plus 20 per cent. Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and Alert Communications, Inc. pursuant to which Lovercius Consultants Limited provides call centre agents and related personnel to Alert Communications, Inc. on a monthly basis for a fee equal to 95 per cent. of all revenues actually collected by Alert Communications, Inc. from its customer’s client. Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and BPO Solutions Inc. pursuant to which Lovercius Consultants Limited provides BPO Solutions Inc. with call centre agents and related personnel on a monthly basis for a fee equal to 95 per cent. of revenues actually collected by BPO Solutions Inc. from its customer’s clients. Service agreement dated 1 April 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and TRG Marketing Services, Inc. pursuant to which Lovercius Consultants Limited provides TRG Marketing Services, Inc. with call centre agents and related personnel on a monthly basis for a fee equal to 95 per cent. of revenues actually collected by TRG Marketing Services, Inc. from its customer’s client. 14.7.2 Intellectual Property An intellectual property licence agreement dated 31 March 2013 between Lovercius Consultants Limited and TRGI pursuant to which TRGI licenses the following software to Lovercius Consultants Limited: BPO Suite, TRG Agent, TRG Dialer, TRG Network Recorder and Web Dialer. 14.8 IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l 14.8.1 Intellectual Property An intellectual property acquisition agreement dated 8 May 2013 between IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l and TRGI pursuant to which IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l purchased the following software from TRGI: Transcription API, TRG Analytics, Client Portal, Data Spy, CMOS, Intake Tool, IVR, Portal DW, Recruitment Management System, Security Module, Service Desk/Trakit, TRG Insight, TRG Whisper, ClickIT, Exit Interview, GP 2013, iSite and TRG Foresight for consideration in the sum of US$1.00. An intellectual property licence agreement dated 8 May 2013 between IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l and TRGI pursuant to which IBEX Global Europe S.à.r.l licenses the following software to TRGI: Transcription API, TRG Analytics, Client Portal, Data Spy, CMOS, Intake Tool, IVR, Portal DW, Recruitment Management System, Security Module, Service Desk/Trakit, TRG Insight, TRG Whisper. 14.9 The notes on the Historic Financial Information state that the expenses incurred by the Group for the period ended 31 December 2012 in respect of the arrangements summarised above totalled $2,568,000. 15. LITIGATION 15.1 IBEX Inc. has a civil lawsuit pending against it in the Circuit Court of Kanawha County, West Virginia. The complaint was filed on 24 August 2012. The plaintiff claims that IBEX Inc. breached a 60-month lease agreement with Davantic LLC for a commercial rental property by failing to pay rent allegedly 135 due. The plaintiff has alleged damages of $12,000 in unpaid taxes on the property plus past and future rents and taxes. IBEX Inc. estimates the maximum potential liability under this lawsuit to be made up of unpaid rents and taxes for the period from July 2011 to March 2014, which rent is stated in the lease as comprising $7,000 per month and taxes of $6,000 per year, plus any prejudgment interest, attorney fees and costs awarded. It should be noted that the plaintiff has a duty to mitigate its damages by reletting the property to a new tenant or by taking other steps to generate economic return from the property. IBEX Inc. intends to defend this matter. 15.2 A complaint has been filed against IBEX Inc. before the West Virginia Human Rights Commission alleging unlawful discrimination on the basis of race and unlawful retaliation within the meaning of the West Virginia Human Rights Act. Ms Thomas is a former employee of TRG Insurance Solutions, LLC. During her employment with TRG Insurance Solutions, LLC, Ms Thomas filed a racial discrimination complaint with the Beckley Human Rights Commission in 2009. Later that year, employees of TRG Insurance Solutions, LLC were informed that the company was closing and all employees would be laid off. In January 2010, Ms Thomas interviewed for a position with IBEX Inc. but did not get the position. She claims that IBEX Inc. failed to hire her because of her race and in retaliation for a complaint she had previously filed against TRG Insurance Solutions, LLC. The Plaintiff seeks $107,940.80 in damages, $92,313.21 in attorneys’ fees and costs, plus future pay and interest. A hearing on this matter was held before the West Virginia Human Rights Commission on 17-18 December 2012. There has not yet been a ruling. IBEX Inc. has defended and intends to continue to defend this case vigorously and it believes that the case is without merit. IBEX Inc. has asserted defences that (a) IBEX Inc.’s employment records show race-neutral employment practices; and (b) IBEX Inc. is as a matter of law not liable for retaliation against a person whom it did not employ. 15.3 Save as set out in paragraphs 15.1 and 15.2 of this Part 4, the Group is not involved nor has been involved in any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings in the previous twelve months which may have or have had in the recent past a significant effect on the Group’s financial position or profitability and, so far as the Directors are aware, there are no such proceedings pending or threatened against the Group. 16. NO SIGNIFICANT CHANGE There has been no significant change in the financial or trading position of the Group since 31 March 2013, being the end of the last financial period for which unaudited interim financial information has been published. 17. WORKING CAPITAL The Directors are of the opinion, having made due and careful enquiry and having taken into account the net proceeds of the Placing, that following Admission, the Group will have sufficient working capital for at least 12 months from the date of Admission. 18. UNITED KINGDOM TAXATION 18.1 Introduction The following paragraphs are intended as a general guide based on current legislation and HMRC practice as at the date of this document regarding the UK tax position of Shareholders who are resident or ordinarily resident in the United Kingdom for tax purposes and who beneficially hold their shares as investments (otherwise than under an individual savings account (“ISA”)). The following paragraphs do not constitute tax advice. In particular, Shareholders who receive shares in connection with an employment contract with the Company or as an office holder, should seek specific advice on their tax position. Any Shareholder who is in doubt as to their tax position, or who is subject to tax in a jurisdiction other than the United Kingdom, is strongly recommended to consult their professional advisers. 136 18.2 Income Tax – taxation of dividends Under current UK taxation legislation, no tax is withheld at source from dividend payments made by the Company. An individual Shareholder who is resident (for tax purposes) in the United Kingdom and who receives a dividend paid by the Company will currently be entitled to receive a tax credit equal to 1/9th of the cash dividend. The individual will be taxable upon the total of the dividend and the related tax credit (the “gross dividend”) which will be regarded as the top slice of the individual’s income. An individual Shareholder who is not liable to income tax at a rate greater than the basic rate (currently 20 per cent.) will pay tax on the gross dividend at the dividend ordinary rate (currently 10 per cent.). Accordingly, the tax credit will be treated as satisfying the individual’s liability to income tax in respect of the dividend and there will be no further tax to pay. It should be noted however that there is no right to claim any repayment of the tax credit from HMRC. To the extent that the gross dividend (taken together with other taxable income) exceeds the individual’s threshold for the higher rate of income tax the individual will, to that extent, pay tax on the gross dividend at the dividend upper rate (currently 32.5 per cent). A UK resident individual Shareholder who is liable to tax at the additional rate will be liable to tax on the gross dividend at the rate of 37.5 per cent. After taking into account the 10 per cent. tax credit, a higher rate tax payer will have further income tax to pay at the rate of 22.5 per cent. on the gross dividend (equivalent to 25 per cent. of the dividend received). An additional rate taxpayer will have further income tax to pay at the rate of 27.5 per cent. on the gross dividend (equivalent to 30.55 per cent. of the dividend received). Tax credits are not repayable to Shareholders with no income tax liability or whose liability to income tax does not exceed the amount of tax credit. Subject to exceptions for certain insurance companies and companies which hold shares as trading stock, a Shareholder which is a company resident (for tax purposes) in the United Kingdom and which receives a dividend paid by the Company will not in most circumstances be liable to corporation tax or income tax on the dividend. Trustees of discretionary trusts are liable to account for income tax at the dividend trust rate, currently 37.5 per cent. of the gross dividend (equivalent to 30.55 per cent. of the dividend received). United Kingdom pension funds and charities are generally exempt from tax on dividends which they receive but are not entitled to claim repayment of the tax credit. A Shareholder resident outside the UK may also be subject to foreign taxation on dividend income under local law. Shareholders not resident in the UK should consult their own tax adviser on the application of such provisions and the procedure for claiming relief. 18.3 Taxation on capital gains for Shareholders To the extent that a Shareholder acquires Ordinary Shares allotted to him, the Ordinary Shares so allotted will, for the purpose of tax on chargeable gains, be treated as acquired on the date of allotment. The amount paid for the Ordinary Shares will generally constitute the base cost of a Shareholder’s holding. A disposal or deemed disposal of Ordinary Shares by a UK resident Shareholder may give rise to a chargeable gain (or allowable loss) for the purposes of UK capital gains tax (“CGT”) (where the Shareholder is an individual or a trustee of a settlement) or UK corporation tax on chargeable gains (where the Shareholder is within the charge to UK corporation tax), depending on their circumstances and subject to any available exemption or relief. As regards an individual Shareholder or trustees of settlements, the principal factors that will determine the extent to which a gain will be subject to CGT are (i) the extent to which he realises any other capital gains in the tax year of assessment in which the gain arises, (ii) the extent to which he was incurred capital losses in that or any earlier tax year or assessment and (iii) the level of annual allowance of tax-free gains in the tax year of assessment in which the disposal takes place. Subject to the availability of any such exemptions, reliefs and/or allowable losses, a disposal of Ordinary Shares by UK resident (or ordinarily resident) individuals, trustees and personal 137 representatives will generally be subject to CGT at the rate of 28 per cent. Individuals whose taxable income for the year in question is less than the upper limit of the basic rate income tax band are subject to CGT at the rate of 18 per cent„ except to the extent that the aggregate of their total taxable income and gains (less allowable deductions) in that year exceeds the upper limit of the basic rate income tax band. Any such excess over the upper Limit is subject to CGT at the rate of 28 per cent. Subject to the availability of any exemptions, reliefs and/or allowable losses, a disposal of Ordinary Shares by companies subject to UK corporation tax will generally be subject to UK corporation tax at the prevailing rate of up to 23 per cent. Indexation allowance may be available to reduce any chargeable gain arising on such disposal but cannot act to create or increase a chargeable loss. 18.4 Stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax (“SDRT”) Currently dealings in Ordinary Shares will normally be subject to stamp duty or SDRT. The transfer on sale of Ordinary Shares will usually be liable to ad valorem stamp duty. at the rate of 0.5 per cent. (rounded up, if necessary, to the next multiple of £5) of the amount or value of the consideration paid. Stamp duty will normally be paid by the purchaser or transferee of the Ordinary Shares. An unconditional agreement to transfer Ordinary Shares will normally give rise to a charge to SDRT, at the rate of 0.5 per cent. of the amount or value of the consideration payable for such shares, but such liability will be cancelled, or any SDRT paid refunded, if the agreement is completed by a duly stamped instrument of transfer within six years of the date of the agreement or, if the agreement was conditional, the date on which the agreement became unconditional. SDRT will normally be the liability of the purchaser or transferee of the Ordinary Shares. Under the CREST system for paperless share transfers, no stamp duty or SDRT will arise on a transfer of shares into the system, unless the transfer into CREST is itself for consideration in money or money’s worth. in which case a liability to SDRT will arise, usually at the rate of 0.5 per cent. of the amount or value of consideration given. Transfers of shares within CREST are generally liable to SDRT at the rate of 0.5 per cent. of the amount or value of the consideration payable rather than stamp duty, and SDRT on relevant transactions settled within the system or reported through it for regulatory purposes should usually be collected and accounted for to HMRC through the CREST system. The above statements are intended to be a general guide to the current stamp duty and SDRT position. Certain categories of person are not liable to stamp duty or SDRT and others may be liable at a higher rate than that referred to above or may, although not primarily liable for the tax, be required to notify and account for it. Special rules apply to agreements made by market intermediaries and to certain sale and repurchase and stock borrowing arrangements. Agreements to transfer shares to charities should not give rise to a liability to stamp duty or SDRT. The Government has announced its intention to abolish stamp duty on shares quoted on growth markets such as the Alternative Investment Market and the ISDX Growth Market. It is expected (subject to the outcome of consultations) that this will be in force from April 2014. 19. GENERAL 19.1 The gross proceeds of the Placing are expected to be £14.6 million. The total costs and expenses relating to Admission and the Placing are payable by the Group and are estimated to amount to approximately £1.3 million (excluding Value Added Tax). The net proceeds of the Placing are expected to be £13.0 million. 19.2 Other than the current application for Admission, the Ordinary Shares have not been admitted to dealings on any recognised investment exchange nor has any application for such admission been made nor are there intended to be any other arrangements for dealings in the Ordinary Shares. 19.3 Liberum has given and not withdrawn its written consent to the inclusion in this document of reference to its name in the form and context in which it appears. 19.4 Cenkos has given and not withdrawn its written consent to the inclusion in this document of reference to its name in the form and context in which it appears. 138 19.5 Grant Thornton UK LLP has given and not withdrawn its written consent to the inclusion in this document of its accountant’s report in Part 3A and references thereto in the form and context in which they appear. Grant Thornton UK LLP’s responsibility for its accountant’s report is as set out in that accountant’s report. 19.6 Where information has been sourced from a third party this information has been accurately reproduced. So far as the Group and the Directors are aware and are able to ascertain from information provided by that third party, no facts have been omitted which would render the reproduced information inaccurate or misleading. 19.6 The accounting reference date of the Group is 30 June. 19.7 The Placing price represents a premium over nominal value of £1.46 per ordinary share. 19.8 It is expected that definitive share certificates will be dispatched by hand or first class post by 5 July 2013. In respect of uncertificated shares it is expected that Shareholders’ CREST stock accounts will be credited on 28 June 2013. 19.9 Save as disclosed above no person directly or indirectly (other than the Group’s professional advisors and trade suppliers or save as disclosed in this document) in the last twelve months received or is contractually entitled to receive, directly or indirectly, from the Group on or after Admission (excluding in either case persons who are professional advisors otherwise than as disclosed in this document and persons who are trade suppliers) any payment or benefit from the Group to the value of £10,000 or more or securities in the Group to such value or any other benefit to such value or entered into any contractual arrangements to receive the same from the Group at the date of Admission. 20. AVAILABILITY OF ADMISSION DOCUMENT Copies of this Admission Document are available free of charge from the Group’s registered office and at the offices of Mishcon de Reya, Summit House, 12 Red Lion Square, London WC1R 4QD during normal business hours on any weekday (Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays excepted) and shall remain available for at least one month after Admission. Dated: 24 June 2013 139 Perivan Financial Print 228885